CA2720771A1 - Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof - Google Patents

Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof Download PDF

Info

Publication number
CA2720771A1
CA2720771A1 CA2720771A CA2720771A CA2720771A1 CA 2720771 A1 CA2720771 A1 CA 2720771A1 CA 2720771 A CA2720771 A CA 2720771A CA 2720771 A CA2720771 A CA 2720771A CA 2720771 A1 CA2720771 A1 CA 2720771A1
Authority
CA
Canada
Prior art keywords
group
nitrogen
oxygen
sulfur
heteroatoms independently
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Granted
Application number
CA2720771A
Other languages
French (fr)
Other versions
CA2720771C (en
Inventor
David Gin
Michelle Adams
Kai DENG
Nicholas Perl
Annie Won
Philip Livingston
Govind Ragupathi
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Memorial Sloan Kettering Cancer Center
Original Assignee
Sloan Kettering Institute for Cancer Research
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Sloan Kettering Institute for Cancer Research filed Critical Sloan Kettering Institute for Cancer Research
Priority to CA2993582A priority Critical patent/CA2993582C/en
Publication of CA2720771A1 publication Critical patent/CA2720771A1/en
Application granted granted Critical
Publication of CA2720771C publication Critical patent/CA2720771C/en
Active legal-status Critical Current
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07HSUGARS; DERIVATIVES THEREOF; NUCLEOSIDES; NUCLEOTIDES; NUCLEIC ACIDS
    • C07H15/00Compounds containing hydrocarbon or substituted hydrocarbon radicals directly attached to hetero atoms of saccharide radicals
    • C07H15/20Carbocyclic rings
    • C07H15/24Condensed ring systems having three or more rings
    • C07H15/256Polyterpene radicals
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07HSUGARS; DERIVATIVES THEREOF; NUCLEOSIDES; NUCLEOTIDES; NUCLEIC ACIDS
    • C07H15/00Compounds containing hydrocarbon or substituted hydrocarbon radicals directly attached to hetero atoms of saccharide radicals
    • C07H15/20Carbocyclic rings
    • C07H15/24Condensed ring systems having three or more rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/56Compounds containing cyclopenta[a]hydrophenanthrene ring systems; Derivatives thereof, e.g. steroids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/70Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/7024Esters of saccharides
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/70Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/7028Compounds having saccharide radicals attached to non-saccharide compounds by glycosidic linkages
    • A61K31/7034Compounds having saccharide radicals attached to non-saccharide compounds by glycosidic linkages attached to a carbocyclic compound, e.g. phloridzin
    • A61K31/704Compounds having saccharide radicals attached to non-saccharide compounds by glycosidic linkages attached to a carbocyclic compound, e.g. phloridzin attached to a condensed carbocyclic ring system, e.g. sennosides, thiocolchicosides, escin, daunorubicin
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/74Synthetic polymeric materials
    • A61K31/80Polymers containing hetero atoms not provided for in groups A61K31/755 - A61K31/795
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/385Haptens or antigens, bound to carriers
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/04Antibacterial agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • A61P31/16Antivirals for RNA viruses for influenza or rhinoviruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • A61P31/18Antivirals for RNA viruses for HIV
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/20Antivirals for DNA viruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/20Antivirals for DNA viruses
    • A61P31/22Antivirals for DNA viruses for herpes viruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P33/00Antiparasitic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P33/00Antiparasitic agents
    • A61P33/02Antiprotozoals, e.g. for leishmaniasis, trichomoniasis, toxoplasmosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • A61P35/02Antineoplastic agents specific for leukemia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/04Immunostimulants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D209/00Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings, condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D209/56Ring systems containing three or more rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07HSUGARS; DERIVATIVES THEREOF; NUCLEOSIDES; NUCLEOTIDES; NUCLEIC ACIDS
    • C07H13/00Compounds containing saccharide radicals esterified by carbonic acid or derivatives thereof, or by organic acids, e.g. phosphonic acids
    • C07H13/02Compounds containing saccharide radicals esterified by carbonic acid or derivatives thereof, or by organic acids, e.g. phosphonic acids by carboxylic acids
    • C07H13/08Compounds containing saccharide radicals esterified by carbonic acid or derivatives thereof, or by organic acids, e.g. phosphonic acids by carboxylic acids having the esterifying carboxyl radicals directly attached to carbocyclic rings
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02ATECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02A50/00TECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE in human health protection, e.g. against extreme weather
    • Y02A50/30Against vector-borne diseases, e.g. mosquito-borne, fly-borne, tick-borne or waterborne diseases whose impact is exacerbated by climate change

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Virology (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Communicable Diseases (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Tropical Medicine & Parasitology (AREA)
  • Microbiology (AREA)
  • Mycology (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • AIDS & HIV (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Steroid Compounds (AREA)
  • Medicines Containing Antibodies Or Antigens For Use As Internal Diagnostic Agents (AREA)
  • Saccharide Compounds (AREA)
  • Pyrane Compounds (AREA)
  • Acyclic And Carbocyclic Compounds In Medicinal Compositions (AREA)
  • Medicines Containing Plant Substances (AREA)

Abstract

The present invention relates to triterpene glycoside saponin-derived adjuvants, syntheses thereof, intermediates thereto, and uses thereof. QS-7 is a potent immuno-adjuvant that is significantly less toxic than QS-21, a related saponin that is currently the favored adjuvant in anticancer and antiviral vaccines. Tedious isolation and purification protocols have hindered the clinical development of QS-7. A novel semi-synthetic method is provided wherein a hydrolyzed prosapogenin mixture is used to synthesize QS-7, QS-21, and related analogs, greatly facilitating access to QS-7 and QS-21 analogs for preclinical and clinical evaluation.

Description

TRITERPENE SAPONINS, METHODS OF SYNTHESIS, AND USES THEREOF
CROSS REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
[0001] The present application claims priority under 35 U.S.C. 119(e) to U.S. provisional application U.S.S.N. 61/043,197, filed April 8, 2008, the contents of which are incorporated herein by reference.

GOVERNMENT SUPPORT
[0002] This invention was made with United States Government support under grant GM58833 awarded by the National Institutes of Health. The United States Government has certain rights in the invention.

FIELD OF THE INVENTION
[0003] The present invention relates to triterpene glycoside saponin-derived adjuvants, syntheses thereof, and intermediates thereto. The invention also provides pharmaceutical compositions comprising compounds of the present invention and methods of using said compounds or compositions in the treatment of infectious diseases and cancer.

BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
[0004] Saponins are glycosidic compounds that are produced as secondary metabolites of steroids and triterpenes. They are widely distributed among plant species and in some marine invertebrates. The chemical structure of saponins imparts a wide range of pharmacological and biological activities, including some potent and efficacious immunological activity. Semi-purified saponin extracts from the bark of the South American Quillaja saponaria Molina tree (Quillajasaponins) exhibit remarkable immunoadjuvant activity. Because the Quillajasaponins are found as a mixture of at least one hundred structurally related saponin glycosides, their separation and isolation is often difficult if not prohibitive.
[0005] The most active fraction of these extracts, designated QS-21, has been found to include a mixture of two principal isomeric triterpene glycoside saponins, each incorporating a quillaic acid triterpene core, flanked on either side by complex oligosaccharides and a stereochemically 1 of 205 rich glycosylated fatty acyl chain. The potency of QS-21 and its favorable toxicity profile in dozens of recent and ongoing vaccine clinical trials (melanoma, breast cancer, small cell lung cancer, prostate cancer, HIV- 1, malaria) have established it as a promising new adjuvant for immune response potentiation and dose-sparing. However, the tolerated dose of QS-21 does not exceed 100 g, above which significant local and systemic side effects arise.
[0006] Access to other potent Quillajasaponins has been hindered by difficulties in obtaining pure species from Quillajasaponin extracts. Futhermore, the structural identity of many Quillajasaponins remains only postulated. The discovery of new Quillajasaponins and related analogs with potent adjuvant activity and low toxicity presents a challenge to the fields of chemical synthesis and medicine.

SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
[0007] The present invention encompasses the recognition that the clinical use of QS-21 as an adjuvant is limited due to toxicity at higher doses, and that QS-7, a related Quillajasaponin, is difficult to isolate in pure form. Moreover, synthetic access to QS-21, QS-7 and other triterpene glycoside saponins is hindered by their structural complexity. The present invention provides compounds that are analogs of QS-21 and QS-7.
[0008] In one aspect, the invention provides compounds of formula I:

O -Z
Me Me H
RY(O)C OO\ / Me H
RRXSOO'/~' O
O W Me v ",Me ORXO H H Me RXO ORX

RxO
I
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
is a single or double bond;
RX,OYORX, W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2ORX, or -C(O)RY;
V is hydrogen or -OR, 2 of 205 Y is CH2, -0-, -NR-, or -NH-Z is hydrogen; a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, and heteroaryl; or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

R~ 0 O R3 RIO O R

R2 or OR1 wherein:
each occurrence of R1 is R" or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
Rc Rd Ro O a O
C
b Ra Rb d wherein:
each occurrence of a, b, and c is independently 0, 1, or 2;
d is an integer from 1-5, wherein each d bracketed structure may be the same or different; with the proviso that the d bracketed structure represents a furanose or pyranose moiety, and the sum of b and c is 1 or 2;
R is hydrogen; an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates; or an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, CI-10 aliphatic, CJ-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is independently hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR", NR2, NHCOR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, Ci_io aliphatic, CJ-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, 3 of 205 or sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R2 is hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OC(O)R4, OC(O)OR4, OC(O)NHR4, OC(O)NRR4, OC(O)SR4, NHC(O)R4, NRC(O)R4, NHC(O)OR4, NHC(O)NHR4, NHC(O)NRR4, N(R4)2, NHR4, NRR4, N3, or an optionally substituted group selected from Ci_io aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R3 is hydrogen, halogen, CH2OR', or an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1_io aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

X ORS
OR O OR
Me Me R4 is Me Me , wherein X is -0- or -NR-; or T-R', wherein:
T is a covalent bond or a bivalent CI-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain; and Rz is hydrogen, halogen, -OR, -OR", -OR', -SR, -NR2, -NC(O)OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur; or two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
4 of 205 each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates;
R3' is -OH, -OR, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;
RxO
R"O O RxO
RS is RxORx ' or RxOMe each occurrence of R'~ is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, CJ-6 aliphatic, or Ci_6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R"' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, Ci_6 aliphatic, or Ci_6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
[0009] According to another aspect, the invention provides compounds of formula IV:
O
Me Me H
Rx0 O)C Me H
Rso_ W Me V "'Me ORx H Me RxO ORx R" O
IV
wherein:
of 205 is a single or double bond;
Yis hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR, OH, NR2, NR3+, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;
WOYOW
W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2ORx, or -C(O)RY;
V is hydrogen or -OR;
RY is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;
RxO
R O \ RxO
RS is RxORx ' or RxOMe each occurrence of R'~ is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1_6 aliphatic, or Ci_6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R"' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, CI-12 aliphatic, or CI-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; and each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group.
[0010] According to another aspect, inventive compounds have been shown to be useful as adjuvants. Thus, in certain embodiments, vaccines are provided comprising one or more bacterial, viral, protozoal, or tumor-associated antigens, and one or more inventive compounds.
In certain embodiments, one or more antigens are non-covalently associated with a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient. In some embodiments, one or more antigens are conjugated covalently to a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
[0011] In another aspect, the present invention provides a method of potentiating an immune response to an antigen, comprising administering to a subject a provided vaccine in an effective amount to potentiate the immune response of said subject to said antigen.
6 of 205
[0012] In another aspect, the present invention provides methods of vaccinating a subject, comprising administering a provided vaccine to said subject. In some embodiments, the subject is human. In some embodiments, the vaccine is administered orally. In other embodiments, the vaccine is administered intramuscularly. In other embodiments, the vaccine is administered subcutaneously. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 10-1000 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 500-1000 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 100-500 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 50-250 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 50-500 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 250-500 g. The antigen to which the subject is vaccinated may be a cancer, bacterial, viral, proatazoal, or self- antigen.
[0013] In another aspect, the invention provides pharmaceutical compositions comprising compounds of the invention and pharmaceutically acceptable excipients. In certain embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition is a vaccine comprising an antigen and an inventive adjuvant.
[0014] In another aspect, the invention provides kits comprising pharmaceutical compositions of inventive compounds. In some embodiments, the kits comprise prescribing information. In some embodiments, such kits include the combination of an inventive adjuvant compound and another immunotherapeutic agent (e.g.). The agents may be packaged separately or together.
The kit optionally includes instructions for prescribing the medication. In certain embodiments, the kit includes multiple doses of each agent. The kit may include sufficient quantities of each component to treat a subject for a week, two weeks, three weeks, four weeks, or multiple months. In certain embodiments, the kit includes one cycle of immunotherapy.
In certain embodiments, the kit includes a sufficient quantity of a pharmaceutical composition to immunize a subject against an antigen long term.
[0015] In another aspect, the invention provides a method of using protecting groups to isolate prosapogenins, the method comprising placing protecting groups on a mixture of prosapogenins and then separating the mixture by suitable means to isolate one or more prosapogenin compounds. In some embodiments, the method comprises the steps of:
(a) providing a mixture of prosapogenins of formula IV-a:

7 of 205 O
Me Me H
RY(O)C O Me H
H Me V "'Me Rs O)A~~ O H W H Me OH O
HO OH
HO
IV-a wherein:
is a single or double bond;
Yis hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR, OH, NR2, NR3+, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;
WOYOW
W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2OR", or -C(O)RY;
V is hydrogen or -OR;
RY is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of esters, amides, and hydrazides;

HO
O HO
HO-X;;-Rsl is OH or HOMe each occurrence of R" is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1_6 aliphatic, or Ci_6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R"' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, CI-12 aliphatic, or CI-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

8 of 205 each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;
(b) treating said compound of formula IV-a under suitable conditions to form a mixture of prosapogenins of formula IV:
O
Me Me H
R O O)C Me H
RSO_ W Me V "'Me OR" O H Me WO ORx RO
IV
wherein each of =, RY, Y', V, and W is as defined for compounds of formula IV-a, Rs is as defined for compounds of formula I, and each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;
and (c) obtaining said compound IV by suitable physical means.
[0016] In some embodiments, the mixture of prosapogenins in step (a) is enriched one or more compounds of formula IV-a. In some embodiments, the mixture of prosapogenins in step (b) is enriched one or more compounds of formula IV.
[0017] The present invention provides novel semi-synthetic methods for synthesizing QS-7, QS-21, and related analogs, the method comprising coupling a triterpene compound with a compound comprising a saccharide to form a compound of formula I. In some embodiments, the method comprises the steps of:
(a) providing a compound of formula IV:

9 of 205 O
Me Me H
R O O)C Me H
RSO/` O O
W Me V "'Me ORx O H H Me RxO ORX

RxO
IV
wherein:
is a single or double bond;
Yis hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR, OH, NR2, NR3+, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;
RX,OORX, W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2ORx, or -C(O)RY;
V is hydrogen or -OR;
RY is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;
RxO
R x0 O RxO
RS is RX ORx ' or RXOMe each occurrence of R'~ is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1_6 aliphatic, or Ci_6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two RX' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, CI-12 aliphatic, or CI-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

of 205 each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;
(b) treating said compound of formula IV under suitable conditions with a compound of formula V:

LG-Z
V
wherein:
Z is hydrogen; a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, and heteroaryl; or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

R~ O O R3 RIO O R

R2 or OR1 wherein:
each occurrence of R1 is R" or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
Rc Rd Ro O O
a b Ra Rb d wherein:
each occurrence of a, b, and c is independently 0, 1, or 2;
d is an integer from 1-5, wherein each d bracketed structure may be the same or different;
with the proviso that the d bracketed structure represents a furanose or pyranose moiety, and the sum of b and c is 1 or 2;
R is hydrogen, an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates;
or an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, Ci_io aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or 11 of 205 sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is independently hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR", NR2, NHCOR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, Ci_io aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-1 0-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R2 is hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OC(O)R4, OC(O)OR4, OC(O)NHR4, OC(O)NRR4, OC(O)SR4, NHC(O)R4, NRC(O)R4, NHC(O)OR4, NHC(O)NHR4, NHC(O)NRR4, N(R4)2, NHR4, NRR4, N3, or an optionally substituted group selected from Ci_io aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R3 is hydrogen, halogen, CH2OR',or an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1_io aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

X ORS
OR O OR
Me Me R4 is Me Me , wherein X is -0- or -NR-; or T-R', wherein:
T is a covalent bond or a bivalent CI-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain; and Rz is hydrogen, halogen, -OR, -OR", -OR', -SR, -NR2, -NC(O)OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 12 of 205 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur; or two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R" is as defined for compounds of formula IV; and LG is a suitable leaving group selected from the group consisting of halogen, imidate, alkoxy, sulphonyloxy, optionally substituted alkylsulphonyl, optionally substituted alkenylsulfonyl, optionally substituted arylsulfonyl, and diazonium moieties;
to give a compound of formula I:

O Y-Z
Me Me H
R O O)C Me H
RSO/-` O O
O W Me v ",Me ORX O H H Me RXO ORX

RxO
I
wherein each of =, RX, RY, Z, V, and W is as defined for compounds of formula IV or V, and Y
is CH2, -0-, -NR-, or -NH-.

Definitions
[0018] As used herein, the following definitions shall apply unless otherwise indicated.
[0019] The term "aliphatic" or "aliphatic group," as used herein, means a straight-chain (i.e., unbranched) or branched, substituted or unsubstituted hydrocarbon chain that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation, or a monocyclic hydrocarbon or bicyclic hydrocarbon that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation, but which is not aromatic (also referred to herein as "carbocycle," .. cyclo aliphatic"
or "cycloalkyl"), that has a single point of attachment to the rest of the molecule. Unless otherwise specified, aliphatic groups contain 1-12 aliphatic carbon atoms. In some 13 of 205 embodiments, aliphatic groups contain 1-6 aliphatic carbon atoms. In some embodiments, aliphatic groups contain 1-5 aliphatic carbon atoms. In other embodiments, aliphatic groups contain 1-4 aliphatic carbon atoms. In still other embodiments, aliphatic groups contain 1-3 aliphatic carbon atoms, and in yet other embodiments, aliphatic groups contain 1-2 aliphatic carbon atoms. In some embodiments, "cycloaliphatic" (or "carbocycle" or "cycloalkyl") refers to a monocyclic C3-C6 hydrocarbon that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation, but which is not aromatic, that has a single point of attachment to the rest of the molecule. Suitable aliphatic groups include, but are not limited to, linear or branched, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl groups and hybrids thereof such as (cycloalkyl)alkyl, (cycloalkenyl)alkyl or (cycloalkyl)alkenyl.
[0020] The term "lower alkyl" refers to a C1_4 straight or branched alkyl group. Exemplary lower alkyl groups are methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, isobutyl, and tert-butyl.
[0021] The term "lower haloalkyl" refers to a C1_4 straight or branched alkyl group that is substituted with one or more halogen atoms.
[0022] The term "heteroatom" means one or more of oxygen, sulfur, nitrogen, phosphorus, or silicon (including, any oxidized form of nitrogen, sulfur, phosphorus, or silicon; the quaternized form of any basic nitrogen or; a substitutable nitrogen of a heterocyclic ring, for example N (as in 3,4-dihydro-2H-pyrrolyl), NH (as in pyrrolidinyl) or NR+ (as in N-substituted pyrrolidinyl)).
[0023] The term "unsaturated," as used herein, means that a moiety has one or more units of unsaturation.
[0024] As used herein, the term "bivalent CI-12 (or Ci_26, CI-16, C1_8) or saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, hydrocarbon chain," refers to bivalent alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene chains that are straight or branched as defined herein.
[0025] The term "alkylene" refers to a bivalent alkyl group. An "alkylene chain" is a polymethylene group, i.e., -(CH2)ri , wherein n is a positive integer, preferably from 1 to 6, from 1 to 4, from 1 to 3, from 1 to 2, or from 2 to 3. A substituted alkylene chain is a polymethylene group in which one or more methylene hydrogen atoms are replaced with a substituent. Suitable substituents include those described below for a substituted aliphatic group.
[0026] The term "alkenylene" refers to a bivalent alkenyl group. A substituted alkenylene chain is a polymethylene group containing at least one double bond in which one or more hydrogen 14 of 205 atoms are replaced with a substituent. Suitable substituents include those described below for a substituted aliphatic group.
[0027] The term "alkynylene" refers to a bivalent alkynyl group. A substituted alkynylene chain is a polymethylene group containing at least one double bond in which one or more hydrogen atoms are replaced with a substituent. Suitable substituents include those described below for a substituted aliphatic group.
[0028] The term "acyl," used alone or a part of a larger moiety, refers to groups formed by removing a hydroxy group from a carboxylic acid.
[0029] The term "halogen" means F, Cl, Br, or I.
[0030] The terms "aralkyl" and "arylalkyl" are used interchangably and refer to alkyl groups in which a hydrogen atom has been replaced with an aryl group. Such groups include, without limitation, benzyl, cinnamyl, and dihyrocinnamyl.
[0031] The term "aryl" used alone or as part of a larger moiety as in "aralkyl," "aralkoxy," or "aryloxyalkyl," refers to monocyclic or bicyclic ring systems having a total of five to fourteen ring members, wherein at least one ring in the system is aromatic and wherein each ring in the system contains 3 to 7 ring members. The term "aryl" may be used interchangeably with the term "aryl ring."
[0032] In certain embodiments of the present invention, "aryl" refers to an aromatic ring system which includes, but not limited to, phenyl, biphenyl, naphthyl, anthracyl and the like, which may bear one or more substituents. Also included within the scope of the term "aryl," as it is used herein, is a group in which an aromatic ring is fused to one or more non-aromatic rings, such as indanyl, phthalimidyl, naphthimidyl, phenanthridinyl, or tetrahydronaphthyl, and the like.
[0033] The terms "heteroaryl" and "heteroar-," used alone or as part of a larger moiety, e.g., "heteroaralkyl," or "heteroaralkoxy," refer to groups having 5 to 10 ring atoms, preferably 5, 6, or 9 ring atoms; having 6, 10, or 14 it electrons shared in a cyclic array;
and having, in addition to carbon atoms, from one to five heteroatoms. The term "heteroatom" refers to nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, and includes any oxidized form of nitrogen or sulfur, and any quaternized form of a basic nitrogen. Heteroaryl groups include, without limitation, thienyl, furanyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyridazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, indolizinyl, purinyl, 15 of 205 naphthyridinyl, and pteridinyl. The terms "heteroaryl" and "heteroar-", as used herein, also include groups in which a heteroaromatic ring is fused to one or more aryl, cycloaliphatic, or heterocyclyl rings, where the radical or point of attachment is on the heteroaromatic ring.
Nonlimiting examples include indolyl, isoindolyl, benzothienyl, benzofuranyl, dibenzofuranyl, indazolyl, benzimidazolyl, benzthiazolyl, quinolyl, isoquinolyl, cinnolinyl, phthalazinyl, quinazolinyl, quinoxalinyl, 4H-quinolizinyl, carbazolyl, acridinyl, phenazinyl, phenothiazinyl, phenoxazinyl, tetrahydroquinolinyl, tetrahydroisoquinolinyl, and pyrido[2,3-b]-1,4-oxazin-3(4H)-one. A heteroaryl group may be mono- or bicyclic. The term "heteroaryl"
may be used interchangeably with the terms "heteroaryl ring," "heteroaryl group," or "heteroaromatic," any of which terms include rings that are optionally substituted. The terms "heteroaralkyl" and "heteroarylalkyl" refer to an alkyl group substituted by a heteroaryl moiety, wherein the alkyl and heteroaryl portions independently are optionally substituted.
[0034] The term "heteroaliphatic," as used herein, means aliphatic groups wherein one or two carbon atoms are independently replaced by one or more of oxygen, sulfur, nitrogen, or phosphorus. Heteroaliphatic groups may be substituted or unsubstituted, branched or unbranched, cyclic or acyclic, and include "heterocycle," "hetercyclyl,"
"heterocycloaliphatic,"
or "heterocyclic" groups.
[0035] As used herein, the terms "heterocycle," "heterocyclyl," "heterocyclic radical," and "heterocyclic ring" are used interchangeably and refer to a stable 5- to 7-membered monocyclic or 7-1 0-membered bicyclic heterocyclic moiety that is either saturated or partially unsaturated, and having, in addition to carbon atoms, one or more, preferably one to four, heteroatoms, as defined above. When used in reference to a ring atom of a heterocycle, the term "nitrogen"
includes a substituted nitrogen. As an example, in a saturated or partially unsaturated ring having 0-3 heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur or nitrogen, the nitrogen may be N (as in 3,4-dihydro-2H-pyrrolyl), NH (as in pyrrolidinyl), or +NR (as in N-substituted pyrrolidinyl).
[0036] A heterocyclic ring can be attached to its pendant group at any heteroatom or carbon atom that results in a stable structure and any of the ring atoms can be optionally substituted.
Examples of such saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclic radicals include, without limitation, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, pyrrolinyl, tetrahydroquinolinyl, tetrahydroisoquinolinyl, decahydroquinolinyl, oxazolidinyl, piperazinyl, 16 of 205
37 PCT/US2009/039954 dioxanyl, dioxolanyl, diazepinyl, oxazepinyl, thiazepinyl, morpholinyl, and quinuclidinyl. The terms "heterocycle," "heterocyclyl," "heterocyclyl ring," "heterocyclic group," "heterocyclic moiety," and "heterocyclic radical," are used interchangeably herein, and also include groups in which a heterocyclyl ring is fused to one or more aryl, heteroaryl, or cycloaliphatic rings, such as indolinyl, 3H-indolyl, chromanyl, phenanthridinyl, or tetrahydroquinolinyl, where the radical or point of attachment is on the heterocyclyl ring. A heterocyclyl group may be mono- or bicyclic.
The term "heterocyclylalkyl" refers to an alkyl group substituted by a heterocyclyl, wherein the alkyl and heterocyclyl portions independently are optionally substituted.
[0037] As used herein, the term "partially unsaturated" refers to a ring moiety that includes at least one double or triple bond. The term "partially unsaturated" is intended to encompass rings having multiple sites of unsaturation, but is not intended to include aryl or heteroaryl moieties, as herein defined.
[0038] In another aspect, the present invention provides "pharmaceutically acceptable"
compositions, which comprise a therapeutically effective amount of one or more of the compounds described herein, formulated together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers (additives) and/or diluents. As described in detail, the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention may be specially formulated for administration in solid or liquid form, including those adapted for the following: oral administration, for example, drenches (aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions), tablets, e.g., those targeted for buccal, sublingual, and systemic absorption, boluses, powders, granules, pastes for application to the tongue; parenteral administration, for example, by subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or epidural injection as, for example, a sterile solution or suspension, or sustained-release formulation; topical application, for example, as a cream, ointment, or a controlled-release patch or spray applied to the skin, lungs, or oral cavity; intravaginally or intrarectally, for example, as a pessary, cream or foam; sublingually; ocularly; transdermally; or nasally, pulmonary and to other mucosal surfaces.
[0039] The phrase "pharmaceutically acceptable" is employed herein to refer to those compounds, materials, compositions, and/or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of human beings and animals 17 of 205 without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problem or complication, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
[0040] The phrase "pharmaceutically acceptable carrier" as used herein means a pharmaceutically-acceptable material, composition or vehicle, such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, or solvent encapsulating material, involved in carrying or transporting the subject compound from one organ, or portion of the body, to another organ, or portion of the body. Each carrier must be "acceptable" in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not injurious to the patient. Some examples of materials which can serve as pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers include: sugars, such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; starches, such as corn starch and potato starch; cellulose, and its derivatives, such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate;
powdered tragacanth;
malt; gelatin; talc; excipients, such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes;
oils, such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; glycols, such as propylene glycol; polyols, such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; esters, such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; agar; buffering agents, such as magnesium hydroxide and aluminum hydroxide; alginic acid; pyrogen-free water; isotonic saline;
Ringer's solution; ethyl alcohol; pH buffered solutions; polyesters, polycarbonates and/or polyanhydrides; and other non-toxic compatible substances employed in pharmaceutical formulations.
[0041] As used herein, the term "pharmaceutically acceptable salt" refers to those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like, and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are well known in the art. For example, S. M. Berge et al., describe pharmaceutically acceptable salts in detail in J. Pharmaceutical Sciences, 1977, 66, 1-19, incorporated herein by reference.
Pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the compounds of this invention include those derived from suitable inorganic and organic acids and bases. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable, nontoxic acid addition salts are salts of an amino group formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid and perchloric acid or with organic acids such as acetic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, succinic acid or malonic acid or by using other methods used in the art such as ion exchange. Other 18 of 205 pharmaceutically acceptable salts include adipate, alginate, ascorbate, aspartate, benzenesulfonate, benzoate, bisulfate, borate, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, formate, fumarate, glucoheptonate, glycerophosphate, gluconate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxy-ethanesulfonate, lactobionate, lactate, laurate, lauryl sulfate, malate, maleate, malonate, methanesulfonate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, nitrate, oleate, oxalate, palmitate, pamoate, pectinate, persulfate, 3-phenylpropionate, phosphate, pivalate, propionate, stearate, succinate, sulfate, tartrate, thiocyanate, p-toluenesulfonate, undecanoate, valerate salts, and the like.
[0042] In other cases, the compounds of the present invention may contain one or more acidic functional groups and, thus, are capable of forming pharmaceutically-acceptable salts with pharmaceutically acceptable bases. The term "pharmaceutically acceptable salts" in these instances refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic base addition salts of compounds of the present invention. These salts can likewise be prepared in situ in the administration vehicle or the dosage form manufacturing process, or by separately reacting the purified compound in its free acid form with a suitable base, such as the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically acceptable metal cation, with ammonia, or with a pharmaceutically acceptable organic primary, secondary, tertiary, or quaternary amine. Salts derived from appropriate bases include alkali metal, alkaline earth metal, ammonium and N+(Ci_4alkyl)4 salts. Representative alkali or alkaline earth metal salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and the like. Further pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, when appropriate, nontoxic ammonium, quaternary ammonium, and amine cations formed using counterions such as halide, hydroxide, carboxylate, sulfate, phosphate, nitrate, loweralkyl sulfonate and aryl sulfonate. Representative organic amines useful for the formation of base addition salts include ethylamine, diethylamine, ethylenediamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, piperazine and the like. (See, for example, Berge et at., supra).
[0043] Unless otherwise stated, structures depicted herein are also meant to include all isomeric (e.g., enantiomeric, diastereomeric, and geometric (or conformational)) forms of the structure;
for example, the R and S configurations for each stereocenter, Z and E double bond isomers, and Z and E conformational isomers. Therefore, single stereochemical isomers as well as 19 of 205 enantiomeric, diastereomeric, and geometric (or conformational) mixtures of the present compounds are within the scope of the invention. Unless otherwise stated, all tautomeric forms of the compounds of the invention are within the scope of the invention.
[0044] Provided compounds may comprise one or more saccharide moieties. Unless otherwise specified, both D- and L-configurations, and mixtures thereof, are within the scope of the invention. Unless otherwise specified, both a- and (3-linked embodiments, and mixtures thereof, are contemplated by the present invention.
[0045] If, for instance, a particular enantiomer of a compound of the present invention is desired, it may be prepared by asymmetric synthesis, chiral chromatography, or by derivation with a chiral auxiliary, where the resulting diastereomeric mixture is separated and the auxiliary group cleaved to provide the pure desired enantiomers. Alternatively, where the molecule contains a basic functional group, such as amino, or an acidic functional group, such as carboxyl, diastereomeric salts are formed with an appropriate optically-active acid or base, followed by resolution of the diastereomers thus formed by fractional crystallization or chromatographic means well known in the art, and subsequent recovery of the pure enantiomers.
[0046] Additionally, unless otherwise stated, structures depicted herein are also meant to include compounds that differ only in the presence of one or more isotopically enriched atoms. For example, compounds having the present structures including the replacement of hydrogen by deuterium or tritium, or the replacement of a carbon by a 13C- or 14C-enriched carbon are within the scope of this invention. Such compounds are useful, for example, as analytical tools, as probes in biological assays, or as therapeutic agents in accordance with the present invention.
[0047] One of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that the synthetic methods, as described herein, utilize a variety of protecting groups. By the term "protecting group," as used herein, it is meant that a particular functional moiety, e.g., 0, S, or N, is masked or blocked, permitting, if desired, a reaction to be carried out selectively at another reactive site in a multifunctional compound. In preferred embodiments, a protecting group reacts selectively in good yield to give a protected substrate that is stable to the projected reactions; the protecting group is preferably selectively removable by readily available, preferably non-toxic reagents that do not attack the other functional groups; the protecting group forms a separable derivative (more preferably without the generation of new stereogenic centers); and the protecting group will preferably have 20 of 205 a minimum of additional functionality to avoid further sites of reaction. As detailed herein, oxygen, sulfur, nitrogen, and carbon protecting groups may be utilized. By way of non-limiting example, hydroxyl protecting groups include methyl, methoxylmethyl (MOM), methylthiomethyl (MTM), t-butylthiomethyl, (phenyldimethylsilyl)methoxymethyl (SMOM), benzyloxymethyl (BOM), p-methoxybenzyloxymethyl (PMBM), (4-methoxyphenoxy)methyl (p-AOM), guaiacolmethyl (GUM), t-butoxymethyl, 4-pentenyloxymethyl (POM), siloxymethyl, 2-methoxyethoxymethyl (MEM), 2,2,2-trichloroethoxymethyl, bis(2-chloroethoxy)methyl, 2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxymethyl (SEMOR), tetrahydropyranyl (THP), 3-bromotetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl, 1-methoxycyclohexyl, 4-methoxytetrahydropyranyl (MTHP), methoxytetrahydrothiopyranyl, 4-methoxytetrahydrothiopyranyl S,S-dioxide, 1-[(2-chloro-4-methyl)phenyl]-4-methoxypiperidin-4-yl (CTMP), 1,4-dioxan-2-yl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydrothiofuranyl, 2,3,3a,4,5,6,7,7a-octahydro-7,8,8-trimethyl-4,7-methanobenzofuran-2-yl, 1-ethoxyethyl, 1-(2-chloroethoxy)ethyl, 1-methyl-l-methoxyethyl, 1-methyl-l-benzyloxyethyl, 1-methyl-l-benzyloxy-2-fluoroethyl, 2,2,2-trichloroethyl, 2-trimethylsilylethyl, 2-(phenylselenyl) ethyl, t-butyl, allyl, p-chlorophenyl, p-methoxyphenyl, 2,4-dinitrophenyl, benzyl, p-methoxybenzyl, 3,4-dimethoxybenzyl, o-nitrobenzyl, p-nitrobenzyl, p-halobenzyl, 2,6-dichlorobenzyl, p-cyanobenzyl, p-phenylbenzyl, 2-picolyl, 4-picolyl, 3-methyl-2-picolyl N-oxido, diphenylmethyl, p,p'-dinitrobenzhydryl, 5-dibenzosuberyl, triphenylmethyl, a-naphthyldiphenylmethyl, p-methoxyphenyldiphenylmethyl, di(p-methoxyphenyl)phenylmethyl, trip-methoxyphenyl)methyl, 4-(4'-bromophenacyloxyphenyl)diphenylmethyl, 4,4',4"-tris(4,5-dichlorophthalimidophenyl)methyl, 4,4',4"-tris(levulinoyloxyphenyl)methyl, 4,4',4"-tris(benzoyloxyphenyl)methyl, 3-(imidazol-1-yl)bis(4',4"-dimethoxyphenyl)methyl, 1,1-bis(4-methoxyphenyl)- 1'-pyrenylmethyl, 9-anthryl, 9-(9-phenyl)xanthenyl, 9-(9-phenyl-10-oxo)anthryl, 1,3-benzodithiolan-2-yl, benzisothiazolyl S,S-dioxido, trimethylsilyl (TMS), triethylsilyl (TES), triisopropylsilyl (TIPS), dimethylisopropylsilyl (IPDMS), diethylisopropylsilyl (DEIPS), dimethylthexylsilyl, t-butyldimethylsilyl (TBDMS), t-butyldiphenylsilyl (TBDPS), tribenzylsilyl, tri-p-xylylsilyl, triphenylsilyl, diphenylmethylsilyl (DPMS), t-butylmethoxyphenylsilyl (TBMPS), formate, benzoylformate, acetate, chloroacetate, dichloroacetate, trichloroacetate, trifluoroacetate, methoxyacetate, triphenylmethoxyacetate, phenoxyacetate,p-chlorophenoxyacetate, 3-phenylpropionate, 4-oxopentanoate (levulinate), 4,4-21 of 205 (ethylenedithio)pentanoate (levulinoyldithioacetal), pivaloate, adamantoate, crotonate, 4-methoxycrotonate, benzoate, p-phenylbenzoate, 2,4,6-trimethylbenzoate (mesitoate), alkyl methyl carbonate, 9-fluorenylmethyl carbonate (Fmoc), alkyl ethyl carbonate, alkyl 2,2,2-trichloroethyl carbonate (Troc), 2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl carbonate (TMSEC), 2-(phenylsulfonyl) ethyl carbonate (Psec), 2-(triphenylphosphonio) ethyl carbonate (Peoc), alkyl isobutyl carbonate, alkyl vinyl carbonate alkyl allyl carbonate, alkylp-nitrophenyl carbonate, alkyl benzyl carbonate, alkylp-methoxybenzyl carbonate, alkyl 3,4-dimethoxybenzyl carbonate, alkyl o-nitrobenzyl carbonate, alkyl p-nitrobenzyl carbonate, alkyl S-benzyl thiocarbonate, 4-ethoxy-l-napththyl carbonate, methyl dithiocarbonate, 2-iodobenzoate, 4-azidobutyrate, 4-nitro-4-methylpentanoate, o-(dibromomethyl)benzoate, 2-formylbenzenesulfonate, 2-(methylthiomethoxy)ethyl, 4-(methylthiomethoxy)butyrate, 2-(methylthiomethoxymethyl)benzoate, 2,6-dichloro-methylphenoxyacetate, 2,6-dichloro-4-(1,1,3,3-tetramethylbutyl)phenoxyacetate, 2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylpropyl)phenoxyacetate, chlorodiphenylacetate, isobutyrate, monosuccinoate, (E)-2-methyl-2-butenoate, o-(methoxycarbonyl)benzoate, a-naphthoate, nitrate, alkyl N,N,N,N'-tetramethylphosphorodiamidate, alkyl N-phenylcarbamate, borate, dimethylphosphinothioyl, alkyl 2,4-dinitrophenylsulfenate, sulfate, methanesulfonate (mesylate), benzylsulfonate, and tosylate (Ts). For protecting 1,2- or 1,3-diols, the protecting groups include methylene acetal, ethylidene acetal, 1-t-butylethylidene ketal, 1-phenylethylidene ketal, (4-methoxyphenyl)ethylidene acetal, 2,2,2-trichloroethylidene acetal, acetonide, cyclopentylidene ketal, cyclohexylidene ketal, cycloheptylidene ketal, benzylidene acetal, p-methoxybenzylidene acetal, 2,4-dimethoxybenzylidene ketal, 3,4-dimethoxybenzylidene acetal, 2-nitrobenzylidene acetal, methoxymethylene acetal, ethoxymethylene acetal, dimethoxymethylene ortho ester, 1-methoxyethylidene ortho ester, 1-ethoxyethylidine ortho ester, 1,2-dimethoxyethylidene ortho ester, a-methoxybenzylidene ortho ester, 1-(N,N-dimethylamino)ethylidene derivative, a-(N,N'-dimethylamino)benzylidene derivative, 2-oxacyclopentylidene ortho ester, di-t-butylsilylene group (DTBS), 1,3-(1,1,3,3-tetraisopropyldisiloxanylidene) derivative (TIPDS), tetra-t-butoxydisiloxane- 1,3-diylidene derivative (TBDS), cyclic carbonates, cyclic boronates, ethyl boronate, and phenyl boronate. Amino-protecting groups include methyl carbamate, ethyl carbamante, 9-fluorenylmethyl carbamate (Fmoc), 9-(2-sulfo)fluorenylmethyl carbamate, 9-(2,7-dibromo)fluoroenylmethyl carbamate, 2,7-di-t-butyl-[9-(10,10-dioxo-10,10,10,10-22 of 205 tetrahydrothioxanthyl)]methyl carbamate (DBD-Tmoc), 4-methoxyphenacyl carbamate (Phenoc), 2,2,2-trichloroethyl carbamate (Troc), 2-trimethylsilylethyl carbamate (Teoc), 2-phenylethyl carbamate (hZ), 1-(1-adamantyl)-1-methylethyl carbamate (Adpoc), 1, 1 -dimethyl-2-haloethyl carbamate, 1, 1 -dimethyl-2,2-dibromoethyl carbamate (DB-t-BOC), 1, 1 -dimethyl-2,2,2-trichloroethyl carbamate (TCBOC), 1-methyl-l-(4-biphenylyl)ethyl carbamate (Bpoc), 1-(3,5-di-t-butylphenyl)- 1-methylethyl carbamate (t-Bumeoc), 2-(2'- and 4'-pyridyl)ethyl carbamate (Pyoc), 2-(N,N-dicyclohexylcarboxamido)ethyl carbamate, t-butyl carbamate (BOC), 1-adamantyl carbamate (Adoc), vinyl carbamate (Voc), allyl carbamate (Alloc), 1-isopropylallyl carbamate (Ipaoc), cinnamyl carbamate (Coc), 4-nitrocinnamyl carbamate (Noc), 8-quinolyl carbamate, N-hydroxypiperidinyl carbamate, alkyldithio carbamate, benzyl carbamate (Cbz), p-methoxybenzyl carbamate (Moz), p-nitobenzyl carbamate, p-bromobenzyl carbamate, p-chlorobenzyl carbamate, 2,4-dichlorobenzyl carbamate, 4-methylsulfinylbenzyl carbamate (Msz), 9-anthrylmethyl carbamate, diphenylmethyl carbamate, 2-methylthioethyl carbamate, 2-methylsulfonylethyl carbamate, 2-(p-toluenesulfonyl)ethyl carbamate, [2-(1,3-dithianyl)]methyl carbamate (Dmoc), 4-methylthiophenyl carbamate (Mtpc), 2,4-dimethylthiophenyl carbamate (Bmpc), 2-phosphonioethyl carbamate (Peoc), 2-triphenylphosphonioisopropyl carbamate (Ppoc), 1,1-dimethyl-2-cyanoethyl carbamate, m-chloro-p-acyloxybenzyl carbamate,p-(dihydroxyboryl)benzyl carbamate, 5-benzisoxazolylmethyl carbamate, 2-(trifluoromethyl)-6-chromonylmethyl carbamate (Tcroc), m-nitrophenyl carbamate, 3,5-dimethoxybenzyl carbamate, o-nitrobenzyl carbamate, 3,4-dimethoxy-6-nitrobenzyl carbamate, phenyl(o-nitrophenyl)methyl carbamate, phenothiazinyl-(10)-carbonyl derivative, N'p-toluenesulfonylaminocarbonyl derivative, N'-phenylaminothiocarbonyl derivative, t-amyl carbamate, S-benzyl thiocarbamate, p-cyanobenzyl carbamate, cyclobutyl carbamate, cyclohexyl carbamate, cyclopentyl carbamate, cyclopropylmethyl carbamate, p-decyloxybenzyl carbamate, 2,2-dimethoxycarbonylvinyl carbamate, o-(N,N-dimethylcarboxamido)benzyl carbamate, 1,1-dimethyl-3-(N,N-dimethylcarboxamido)propyl carbamate, 1, 1 -dimethylpropynyl carbamate, di(2-pyridyl)methyl carbamate, 2-furanylmethyl carbamate, 2-iodoethyl carbamate, isoborynl carbamate, isobutyl carbamate, isonicotinyl carbamate, p-(p'-methoxyphenylazo)benzyl carbamate, 1-methylcyclobutyl carbamate, 1-methylcyclohexyl carbamate, 1-methyl-l-cyclopropylmethyl carbamate, 1-methyl-l-(3,5-dimethoxyphenyl)ethyl carbamate, 1-methyl-l-(p-23 of 205 phenylazophenyl) ethyl carbamate, 1-methyl-l-phenylethyl carbamate, 1-methyl-l-(4-pyridyl)ethyl carbamate, phenyl carbamate, p-(phenylazo)benzyl carbamate, 2,4,6-tri-t-butylphenyl carbamate, 4-(trimethylammonium)benzyl carbamate, 2,4,6-trimethylbenzyl carbamate, formamide, acetamide, chloroacetamide, trichloroacetamide, trifluoroacetamide, phenylacetamide, 3-phenylpropanamide, picolinamide, 3-pyridylcarboxamide, N-benzoylphenylalanyl derivative, benzamide, p-phenylbenzamide, o-nitophenylacetamide, o-nitrophenoxyacetamide, acetoacetamide, (N'-dithiobenzyloxycarbonylamino)acetamide, 3-(p-hydroxyphenyl)propanamide, 3-(o-nitrophenyl)propanamide, 2-methyl-2-(o-nitrophenoxy)propanamide, 2-methyl-2-(o-phenylazophenoxy)propanamide, 4-chlorobutanamide, 3-methyl-3-nitrobutanamide, o-nitrocinnamide, N-acetylmethionine derivative, o-nitrobenzamide, o-(benzoyloxymethyl)benzamide, 4,5 -diphenyl-3 -oxazo lin-2- one, N-phthalimide, N-dithiasuccinimide (Dts), N-2,3-diphenylmaleimide, N-2,5-dimethylpyrrole, N-1,1,4,4-tetramethyldisilylazacyclopentane adduct (STABASE), 5-substituted 1,3-dimethyl-1,3,5-triazacyclohexan-2-one, 5-substituted 1,3 -dibenzyl- 1,3,5 -triazacyclohexan-2-one, 1-substituted 3,5-dinitro-4-pyridone, N-methylamine, N-allylamine, N-[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy]methylamine (SEM), N-3-acetoxypropylamine, N-(1-isopropyl-4-nitro-2-oxo-3-pyroolin-3-yl)amine, quaternary ammonium salts, N-benzylamine, N-di(4-methoxyphenyl)methylamine, N-dibenzosuberylamine, N-triphenylmethylamine (Tr), N-[(4-methoxyphenyl)diphenylmethyl] amine (MMTr), N-9-phenylfluorenylamine (PhF), N-2,7-dichloro-9-fluorenylmethyleneamine, N-ferrocenylmethylamino (Fcm), N-2-picolylamino N'-oxide, N- 1, 1 -dimethylthiomethyleneamine, N-benzylideneamine, N-p-methoxybenzylideneamine, N-diphenylmethyleneamine, N-[(2-pyridyl)mesityl]methyleneamine, N-(N',N'-dimethylaminomethylene)amine, NN'-isopropylidenediamine, N-p-nitrobenzylideneamine, N-salicylideneamine, N-S-chlorosalicylideneamine, N-(5-chloro-2-hydroxyphenyl)phenylmethyleneamine, N-cyclohexylideneamine, N-(5,5-dimethyl-3-oxo-1-cyclohexenyl)amine, N-borane derivative, N-diphenylborinic acid derivative, N-[phenyl(pentacarbonylchromium- or tungsten)carbonyl]amine, N-copper chelate, N-zinc chelate, N-nitroamine, N-nitrosoamine, amine N-oxide, diphenylphosphinamide (Dpp), dimethylthiophosphinamide (Mpt), diphenylthiophosphinamide (Ppt), dialkyl phosphoramidates, dibenzyl phosphoramidate, diphenyl phosphoramidate, benzenesulfenamide, o-24 of 205 nitrobenzenesulfenamide (Nps), 2,4-dinitrobenzenesulfenamide, pentachlorobenzenesulfenamide, 2-nitro-4-methoxybenzenesulfenamide, triphenylmethylsulfenamide, 3-nitropyridinesulfenamide (Npys), p-toluenesulfonamide (Ts), benzenesulfonamide, 2,3,6,-trimethyl-4-methoxybenzenesulfonamide (Mtr), 2,4,6-trimethoxybenzenesulfonamide (Mtb), 2,6-dimethyl-4-methoxybenzenesulfonamide (Pme), 2,3,5,6-tetramethyl-4-methoxybenzenesulfonamide (Mte), 4-methoxybenzenesulfonamide (Mbs), 2,4,6-trimethylbenzenesulfonamide (Mts), 2,6-dimethoxy-4-methylbenzenesulfonamide (iMds), 2,2,5,7,8-pentamethylchroman-6-sulfonamide (Pmc), methanesulfonamide (Ms), (3-trimethylsilylethanesulfonamide (SES), 9-anthracenesulfonamide, 4-(4',8'-dimethoxynaphthylmethyl)benzenesulfonamide (DNMBS), benzylsulfonamide, trifluoromethylsulfonamide, and phenacylsulfonamide. Exemplary protecting groups are detailed herein, however, it will be appreciated that the present invention is not intended to be limited to these protecting groups; rather, a variety of additional equivalent protecting groups can be readily identified using the above criteria and utilized in the method of the present invention.
Additionally, a variety of protecting groups are described by Greene and Wuts (supra).
[0048] As described herein, compounds of the invention may contain "optionally substituted"
moieties. In general, the term "substituted," whether preceded by the term "optionally" or not, means that one or more hydrogens of the designated moiety are replaced with a suitable substituent. Unless otherwise indicated, an "optionally substituted" group may have a suitable substituent at each substitutable position of the group, and when more than one position in any given structure may be substituted with more than one substituent selected from a specified group, the substituent may be either the same or different at every position.
Combinations of substituents envisioned by this invention are preferably those that result in the formation of stable or chemically feasible compounds. The term "stable," as used herein, refers to compounds that are not substantially altered when subjected to conditions to allow for their production, detection, and, in certain embodiments, their recovery, purification, and use for one or more of the purposes disclosed herein.
[0049] Suitable monovalent substituents on a substitutable carbon atom of an "optionally substituted" group are independently halogen; -(CH2)0- 4R ; -(CH2)0_40R ; -O(CH2)0_4R , -0-(CH2)0_4C(O)OR ; -(CH2)0_4CH(OR )2; -(CH2)0-4SR ; -(CH2)o_4Ph, which may be substituted 25 of 205 with R ; -(CH2)040(CH2)o1Ph which may be substituted with R ; -CH=CHPh, which may be substituted with R ; -(CH2)040(CH2)0i-pyridyl which may be substituted with R
; -NO2; -CN;
-N3; -(CH2)a_4N(R )2, -(CH2)0_4N(R )C(O)R ; N(R )C(S)R ; -(CH2)0_4N(R )C(O)NR
2, -N(R )C(S)NR 2, -(CH2)0_4N(R )C(O)OR ; N(R )N(R )C(O)R ; -N(R )N(R )C(O)NR 2, -N(R )N(R )C(O)OR ; -(CH2)0-4C(O)R ; -C(S)R ; -(CH2)0-4C(O)OR ; -(CH2)0-4C(O)SR ;
-(CH2)0-4C(O)OSiR 3; -(CH2)0-40C(O)R ; -OC(O)(CH2)0_4SR-, SC(S)SR ; -(CH2)0-4SC(O)R ;
-(CH2)0-4C(O)NR 2, -C(S)NR 2, -C(S)SR ; -SC(S)SR , -(CH2)0-40C(O)NR 2;
-C(O)N(OR )R ; -C(O)C(O)R ; -C(O)CH2C(O)R ; -C(NOR )R ; -(CH2)04SSR ; -(CH2)0 4S(0)2R ; -(CH2)0-4S(0)20R ; -(CH2)0-40S(0)2R ; -S(0)2NR 2; -(CH2)0-4S(O)R ;
-N(R )S(0)2NR 2, N(R )S(O)2R ; N(OR )R ; -C(NH)NR 2; -P(0)2R ; -P(O)R 2, -OP(O)R 2;
-OP(O)(OR )2; SiR 3; -(CI_4 straight or branched alkylene)O-N(R )2, or -(CI_4 straight or branched alkylene)C(O)O-N(R )2, wherein each R may be substituted as defined below and is independently hydrogen, Ci_6 aliphatic, -CH2Ph, -O(CH2)o_1Ph, -CH2-(5-6-membered heteroaryl ring), or a 5-6-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, or, notwithstanding the definition above, two independent occurrences of R , taken together with their intervening atom(s), form a 3-12-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl mono- or bicyclic ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, which may be substituted as defined below.
[0050] Suitable monovalent substituents on R (or the ring formed by taking two independent occurrences of R together with their intervening atoms), are independently halogen, -(CH2)o_ 2R', -(haloR'), -(CH2)o_20H, -(CH2)o_20R', -(CH2)o_2CH(OR')2; -O(haloR'), -CN, N3, -(CH2)0_2C(O)R', -(CH2)0_2C(O)OH, -(CH2)0_2C(O)OR', -(CH2)0_2SR', -(CH2)0_2SH, -(CH2)0_ 2NH2, -(CH2)o_2NHR', -(CH2)o_2NR'2, -NO2, -SiR'3, -OSiR'3, -C(O)SR', -(C1_4 straight or branched alkylene)C(O)OR', or -SSR' wherein each R' is unsubstituted or where preceded by "halo" is substituted only with one or more halogens, and is independently selected from C1-4 aliphatic, -CH2Ph, -O(CH2)o_1Ph, or a 5-6-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur. Suitable divalent substituents on a saturated carbon atom of R include =0 and =S.

26 of 205
[0051] Suitable divalent substituents on a saturated carbon atom of an "optionally substituted"
group include the following: =O, =S, =NNR*2, =NNHC(O)R*, =NNHC(O)OR*, =NNHS(0)2R*, =NR*, =NOR*, -O(C(R*2))2_30-, or -S(C(R*2))2_3S-, wherein each independent occurrence of R* is selected from hydrogen, Ci_6 aliphatic which may be substituted as defined below, or an unsubstituted 5-6-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur. Suitable divalent substituents that are bound to vicinal substitutable carbons of an "optionally substituted" group include: -O(CR*2)2_30-, wherein each independent occurrence of R* is selected from hydrogen, Ci_6 aliphatic which may be substituted as defined below, or an unsubstituted 5-6-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur.
[0052] Suitable substituents on the aliphatic group of R* include halogen, -R', -(haloR'), -OH, -OR', -O(haloR'), -CN, -C(O)OH, -C(O)OR', NH2, NHR', -NR'2, or -NO2, wherein each R' is unsubstituted or where preceded by "halo" is substituted only with one or more halogens, and is independently Ci_4 aliphatic, -CH2Ph, -O(CH2)o1Ph, or a 5-6-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur.
[0053] Suitable substituents on a substitutable nitrogen of an "optionally substituted" group include -Rt, -NRt2, -C(O)Rt, -C(O)ORt, -C(O)C(O)Rt, -C(O)CH2C(O)Rt, -S(O)2Rt, -S(O)2NRt2, -C(S)NRt2, -C(NH)NRt2, or N(Rt)S(O)2Rt; wherein each Rt is independently hydrogen, C1_6 aliphatic which may be substituted as defined below, unsubstituted -OPh, or an unsubstituted 5-6-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, or, notwithstanding the definition above, two independent occurrences of Rt, taken together with their intervening atom(s) form an unsubstituted 3-12-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl mono- or bicyclic ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur.
Suitable substituents on the aliphatic group of Rt are independently halogen, -R', -(haloR'), -OH, -OR', -O(haloR'), -CN, -C(O)OH, -C(O)OR', NH2, NHR', -NR'2, or -NO2, wherein each R' is unsubstituted or where preceded by "halo" is substituted only with one or more halogens, and is independently Ci_4 aliphatic, -CH2Ph, -O(CH2)o_1Ph, or a 5-6-membered 27 of 205 saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur.
[0054] The phrases "parenteral administration" and "administered parenterally"
as used herein means modes of administration other than enteral and topical administration, usually by injection, and includes, without limitation, intravenous, intramuscular, intraarterial, intrathecal, intracapsular, intraorbital, intracardiac, intradermal, intraperitoneal, transtracheal, subcutaneous, subcuticular, intraarticulare, subcapsular, subarachnoid, intraspinal and intrasternal injection and infusion.
[0055] The phrases "systemic administration," "administered systemically,"
"peripheral administration" and "administered peripherally" as used herein mean the administration of a compound, drug or other material other than directly into the central nervous system, such that it enters the patient's system and, thus, is subject to metabolism and other like processes, for example, subcutaneous administration.
[0056] The term "enriched" as used herein refers to a mixture having an increased proportion of one or more species. In some embodiments, the mixture is "enriched" following a process that increases the proportion of one or more desired species in the mixture. In some embodiments, the desired species comprise(s) greater than 10% of the mixture. In some embodiments, the desired species comprise(s) greater than 25% of the mixture. In some embodiments, the desired species comprise(s) greater than 40% of the mixture. In some embodiments, the desired species comprise(s) greater than 60% of the mixture. In some embodiments, the desired species comprise(s) greater than 75% of the mixture. In some embodiments, the desired species comprise(s) greater than 85% of the mixture. In some embodiments, the desired species comprise(s) greater than 90% of the mixture. In some embodiments, the desired species comprise(s) greater than 95% of the mixture. Such proportions can be measured any number of ways, for example, as a molar ratio, volume to volume, or weight to weight.
[0057] The term "pure" refers to compounds that are substantially free of compounds of related non-target structure or chemical precursors (when chemically synthetized).
This quality may be measured or expressed as "purity." In some embodiments, a target compound has less than about 30%, 20%, 10%, 5%, 2%, 1%, 0.5%, and 0.1% of non-target structures or chemical 28 of 205 precursors. In certain embodiments, a pure compound of present invention is only one prosapogenin compound (i.e., separation of target prosapogenin from other prosapogenins).
[0058] The term "carbohydrate" refers to a sugar or polymer of sugars. The terms "saccharide", "polysaccharide", "carbohydrate", and "oligosaccharide", may be used interchangeably. Most carbohydrates are aldehydes or ketones with many hydroxyl groups, usually one on each carbon atom of the molecule. Carbohydrates generally have the molecular formula C,,H2,,O,,. A
carbohydrate may be a monosaccharide, a disaccharide, trisaccharide, oligosaccharide, or polysaccharide. The most basic carbohydrate is a monosaccharide, such as glucose, sucrose, galactose, mannose, ribose, arabinose, xylose, and fructose. Disaccharides are two joined monosaccharides. Exemplary disaccharides include sucrose, maltose, cellobiose, and lactose.
Typically, an oligosaccharide includes between three and six monosaccharide units (e.g., raffinose, stachyose), and polysaccharides include six or more monosaccharide units. Exemplary polysaccharides include starch, glycogen, and cellulose. Carbohydrates may contain modified saccharide units such as 2'-deoxyribose wherein a hydroxyl group is removed, 2'-fluororibose wherein a hydroxyl group is replace with a fluorine, or N-acetylglucosamine, a nitrogen-containing form of glucose. (e.g., 2'-fluororibose, deoxyribose, and hexose).
Carbohydrates may exist in many different forms, for example, conformers, cyclic forms, acyclic forms, stereoisomers, tautomers, anomers, and isomers.

BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0059] Figure la depicts the chemical structure of QS-7-Api.
[0060] Figure lb depicts the chemical structures of QS-21-Api and QS-21-Xyl.
Percentages correspond to the natural abundance of each isomer in isolated extracts of QS-21.
[0061] Figures 2a-c show Anti-GD3 and Anti-KLH antibody titers after vaccination with GD3-KLH conjugate (10 g) with adjuvants NQS-21, SQS-21-Mix, SQS-21-Api, or SQS-21-Xyl each at 20 g doses. Each value represents median value of five mice (sera tested 7 days after 3rd and 4th vaccination). NQS-21 = naturally derived QS-21; SQS-21-Mix = synthetic QS-21.
[0062] Figure 3 shows a comparison of cell surface reactivity against cell line SK-Mel-28 between vaccinations with various SQS-adjuvants at 20 g doses.

29 of 205
[0063] Figure 4 depicts a toxicity study in C57BL/6J Female Mice injected with GD3-KLH (10 g) plus SQS-21-Mix, SQS-21-Api, or SQS-21-Xyl (20 g each), compared to that with no adjuvant or natural NQS-21 (20 g).
[0064] Figure 5 shows the results on adjuvant activity of synthetic SQS-analogues employing GD3-KLH antigen. Antibody-titers are median values of groups of five mice, wherein adjuvant dose is 10 g. SQS-7 = synthetic QS-7-Api. SQS-0101 = compound 1-9; SQS-0102 =
compound 1-10; SQS-0103 = compound 1-8.
[0065] Figures 6-14 show 'H-NMR spectra of compounds described herein.
[0066] Figures 15a-b are high-performance liquid chromatography traces of a 1:1 mixture of natural and semisynthetic QS-7-Api.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF CERTAIN EMBODIMENTS
[0067] The clinical success of anticancer and antimicrobial vaccines critically depends on the identification of, and access to, novel potent adjuvants with attenuated toxicity. In this context, specific fractions from extracts of the bark of Quillaja saponaria (QS) have proven to be exceedingly powerful adjuvants in immunotherapy. The QS-21 fraction (Kensil, C. R.; Patel, U.;
Lennick, M.; Marciani, D. J. Imimunol. 1991, 146, 431-437), comprising isomeric forms of a complex triterpene glycoside saponin (Soltysik, S.; Wu, J. Y.; Recchia, J.;
Wheeler, D. A.;
Newman, M. J.; Coughlin, R. T.; Kensil, C. R. Vaccine 1995,13,1403-1410;
Kensil, C. R. Crit.
Rev. Ther. Drug Carrier Syst. 1996, 13, 1-55), is currently the most promising immuno-potentiator (Kim, S. K.; Ragupathi, G.; Musselli, C.; Choi, S. J.; Park, Y.
S.; Livingston, P. O.
Vaccine 2000, 18, 597-603) in several antitumor (melanoma, breast, small cell lung cancer, prostate) (Livingston, P. 0.; Ragupathi, G. Hum. Vaccines 2006, 2, 137-143) and infectious-disease (HIV, malaria) vaccine therapies (Sasaki, S.; Sumino, K.; Hamajima, K.; Fukushima, J.;
Ishii, N.; Kawamoto, S.; Mohri, H.; Kensil, C. R.; Okuda, K. J. Virol. 1998, 72, 4931-4939;
Evans, T. G., et al. Vaccine 2001, 19, 2080-2091; Kashala, 0., et al. Vaccine 2002, 20, 2263-2277; Carcaboso, A. M.; Hernandez, R. M.; Igartua, M.; Rosas, J. E.;
Patarroyo, M. E.; Pedraz, J.
L. Vaccine 2004, 22, 1423-1432). However, the tolerated dose of QS-21 in cancer patients typically does not exceed 100 g, above which significant local erythema and systemic flu-like 30 of 205 symptoms arise. On the other hand, QS-7, another QS extract fraction, was found not only to possess significant stand-alone adjuvant activity (Kensil, 1991; Kensil, 1998, supra), but also to induce remarkable synergistic immune response augmentation (Kensil, C. A., U.S. Pat. No.
6,231,859) when co-administered with QS-21, allowing for the administration of less QS-21.
Importantly, QS-7, unlike QS-21, exhibited negligible toxicity in mice. The present invention provides an efficient semi-synthetic method of synthesizing analogs of QS-7 and QS-21, thereby signficantly reducing the number of synthetic steps required to access this potent class of adjuvants.

Compounds
[0068] Compounds of this invention include those described generally above, and are further illustrated by the classes, subclasses, and species disclosed herein. In some embodiments, provided compounds are analogs of naturally occurring triterpene glycoside saponins and intermediates thereto. For purposes of this invention, the chemical elements are identified in accordance with the Periodic Table of the Elements, CAS version, Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, 75th Ed. Additionally, general principles of organic chemistry are described in Organic Chemistry, Thomas Sorrell, University Science Books, Sausalito: 1999, and March's Advanced Organic Chemistry, 5th Ed., Ed.: Smith, M.B. and March, J., John Wiley & Sons, New York:
2001, the entire contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference.

Description of Exemplary Compounds
[0069] In some embodiments, provided compounds are analogs of Quillajasaponins. In some embodiments, provided compounds are prosapogenins. In certain embodiments, provided compounds are analogs of QS-7 and QS-21 and possess potent adjuvant activity.
[0070] In certain embodiments, the present invention provides a compound of formula I:
31 of 205 O -Z
Me Me H
RY(O)C O Me H
RO
RSO_ 0 W Me V ",Me OR H H Me RxO ORx RxO
I
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
is a single or double bond;
R`'OOR`' W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2OR", or -C(O)R';
V is hydrogen or -OR, Y is CH2, -0-, -NR-, or -NH-Z is hydrogen; a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, and heteroaryl; or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

- O R3 R,o O R3 R~ O R
R2 or OR1 wherein:
each occurrence of R1 is R" or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
R' Rd Ro O O
a b Ra Rb d wherein:
each occurrence of a, b, and c is independently 0, 1, or 2;
32 of 205 d is an integer from 1-5, wherein each d bracketed structure may be the same or different; with the proviso that the d bracketed structure represents a furanose or pyranose moiety, and the sum of b and c is 1 or 2;
R is hydrogen, an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates; or an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, CI-10 aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is independently hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR", NR2, NHCOR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, CI-10 aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R2 is hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR', OC(O)R4, OC(O)OR4, OC(O)NHR4, OC(O)NRR4, OC(O)SR4, NHC(O)R4, NRC(O)R4, NHC(O)OR4, NHC(O)NHR4, NHC(O)NRR4, N(R4)2, NHR4, NRR4, N3, or an optionally substituted group selected from CI-10 aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R3 is hydrogen, halogen, CH2OR', or an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C,_io aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

33 of 205 X OR' VY
OR O OR
Me Me R4 is Me Me , wherein X is -0- or -NR-; or T-R', wherein:
T is a covalent bond or a bivalent CI-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain; and Rz is hydrogen, halogen, -OR, -ORX, -OR', -SR, -NR2, -NC(O)OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, C1_6 aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur; or two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates.
R'' is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of esters, amides, and hydrazides;

RXO
RXO O \ RXO
RS is RX~ ' or RXOMe each occurrence of R~ is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, CI-6 aliphatic, or CI-6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two RX' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

34 of 205 each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, CI-12 aliphatic, or CI-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
R" 'OOR"
[0071] As defined above, W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2OR', or -C(O)ORY. In certain embodiments, W is methyl. In other embodiments, W is -CHO. In certain embodiments, W is -CH2OR". In other embodiments, W is -C(O)ORY. In some embodiments, W is -CH2OH. In other embodiments, W is -CH2OBn. In other embodiments, W is -CH2OSiEt3. In certain embodiments, W is -C(O)OH. In other embodiments, W is -C(O)OBn.
[0072] In certain embodiments, V is -OR". In some embodiments, V is -OH. In some embodiments, V is hydrogen.
[0073] As defined above, -- represents a single or double bond. It will be appreciated that compounds of formula I can be subjected to hydrogenation conditions (infra) that reduce the double bond to a single bond.
[0074] As defined above, Y is CH2, -0-, -NR-, or -NH-. In certain embodiments, Y is CH2. In certain embodiments, Y is -0-. In other embodiments, Y is -NR-. In some embodiments, Y is -NH-.
[0075] In certain embodiments, Z is hydrogen; a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, and heteroaryl.
[0076] In some embodiments, Z comprises a carbohydrate. In some embodiments, Z
is not hydrogen. In other embodiments, Z is acyl.
[0077] In some embodiments, a Z comprises a linker group that separates a carbohydrate from Y. In some embodiments, the linker group is an optionally substituted, straight or branched CI-12 aliphatic or heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, the linker group is -(CH2)k-, wherein k is an integer between 1 and 10, inclusive.

35 of 205
[0078] In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted aliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CI-30 aliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CI-20 aliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CI-16 aliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CI-12 aliphatic group.
In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CI-10 aliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CJ-6 aliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted C2_12 aliphatic group.
[0079] In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CI-30 heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted C1_20 heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CI-16 heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CI-12 heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted Cl_ heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted CJ-heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted C2_12 heteroaliphatic group.
[0080] In certain embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted heteroaryl group having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur. In certain embodiments, Z
is is an optionally substituted 5-12-membered heteroaryl group. In certain embodiments, Z is is an optionally substituted 5- 1 0-membered heteroaryl group. In certain embodiments, Z is is an optionally substituted 6-8-membered heteroaryl group.
[0081] In certain embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted aryl group. In certain embodiments, Z is is an optionally substituted 6-12-membered aryl group. In certain embodiments, Z is is an optionally substituted 6-10-membered aryl group. In certain embodiments, Z is is an optionally substituted 6-8-membered aryl group.
[0082] In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted heterocyclyl group.
In certain embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted 4-7-membered heterocyclyl group having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
[0083] In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted arylalkyl group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted C7_12 arylalkyl group. In some embodiments, Z is an 36 of 205 optionally substituted C7_10 arylalkyl group. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted C7_8 arylalkyl group.
[0084] In some embodiments, Z is a monosaccharide. In some embodiments, Z is an oligosaccharide. In certain embodiments, Z is a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
R~ O O R3 RIO O R

R2 or OR1 wherein each of R', R2, and R3 is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[0085] In certain embodiments, Z has the structure:

R' Rd Ro O
~ O
b Ra Rb wherein each of R , Ra, Rb, Rc, Rd, a, b, c, and d is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[0086] As described above, the Z moiety is linked to the triterpene core via Y. In some embodiments, Z is a monosaccharide and is D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, Z is a monosaccharide and is L-fucosyl. In some embodiments, Z is a monosaccharide and is not fucosyl. In some embodiments, Z is a monosaccharide and is not (3-D-fucosyl.
[0087] In some embodiments, Z is an oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is fucosyl. In some embodiments, Z is an oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, Z is an oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not (3-D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, Z
is an oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not a-D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, Z is an oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y
is not fucosyl.
[0088] In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted monosaccharide and is D-fucosyl.
In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted monosaccharide and is L-fucosyl. In some embodiments, Z is an optionally substituted monosaccharide and is not (3-D-fucosyl. In some 37 of 205 embodiments, when a carbohydrate domain of Z is directly attached to Y, the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not fucosyl. In certain embodiments, when Y-Z
is -OH, -OMe, or -Oallyl, at least seven R" groups are silyl ethers. In some embodiments, Z
and R" are not all simulataneously hydrogen or methyl. In some embodiments, Y-Z is not -OMe. In some embodiments, Y-Z is not -OH. In some embodiments, Y-Z is not -Oallyl. In some embodiments, Y-Z is not -OH or -OMe if all R" groups are simultaneously hydrogen or if at least four R" groups are simultaneously methyl.
[0089] In some embodiments, R3' is not a lipophilic group. In some embodiments, when a carbohydrate moiety of Z is non-acylated and all R" are simulataneously hydrogen, the 3-0-glucuronic acid residue of the triterpene is not covalently attached, directly or indirectly, to a compound having a lipophilic domain, wherein the lipophilic domain is attached via the carboxylic acid carbon atom present on the 3-0-glucuronic acid residue.
[0090] In certain embodiments, each occurrence of R3' is independently -OH. In certain embodiments, each occurrence of R3' is independently -OR. In certain embodiments, each occurrence of R3' is independently a carboxyl protecting group. Suitable carboxyl protecting groups are well known in the art and include those described in detail in Protecting Groups in Organic Synthesis, T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, 3rd edition, John Wiley &
Sons, 1999, the entirety of which is incorporated herein by reference.
[0091] In some embodiments, each occurrence of RY, when taken with its attached carbonyl group, independently comprises an ester. In some embodiments, each occurrence of RY, when taken with its attached carbonyl group, independently comprises an amide. In some embodiments, each occurrence of RY, when taken with its attached carbonyl group, independently comprises a hydrazide.
[0092] In some embodiments, each occurrence of RY is independently -OBn. In other embodiments, each occurrence of RY is independently -OEt.
[0093] In certain embodiments, each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen. In certain embodiments, each occurrence of R" is independently a suitable hydroxyl protecting group.
Suitable hydroxyl protecting groups are well known in the art and include those described herein and by Greene (supra). In some embodiments, no more than four R" groups are simultaneously methyl.

38 of 205 RxO
R xO_~O\ \ RxO
R"OB"
[0094] In some embodiments, Rs is ORx . In some embodiments, Rs is RxOMe HO
O
p HO
HO
HO
[0095] In some embodiments, R" is OH . In some embodiments, W1 is HOMe
[0096] In some embodiments, each occurrence of Rx, when taken with its attached oxygen atom, independently comprises a methyl ether, ethyl ether, benzyl ether, silyl ether, ester, acetal, ketal, or carbonate. In some embodiments, Rx comprises a methyl ether. In some embodiments, Rx comprises a ethyl ether. In some embodiments, Rx comprises a benzyl ether. In some embodiments, Rx comprises a silyl ether. In some embodiments, Rx comprises an ester. In some embodiments, Rx comprises an acetal. In some embodiments, Rx comprises a ketal. In some embodiments, Rx comprises a carbonate.
[0097] In certain embodiments, Rx is methyl. In certain embodiments, Rx is ethyl. In certain embodiments, Rx is benzyl. In certain embodiments, Rx is SiR3. In certain embodiments, Rx is SiMe3. In certain embodiments, Rx is TBS.
O O
[0098] In certain embodiments, Rx is + -R. In certain embodiments, W is '~''OR
. In certain O

embodiments, R, is NR2
[0099] In some embodiments, two -OR' attached to adjacent carbon atoms on a saccharide ring are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur. In some embodiments, two -ORX attached to adjacent carbon atoms on a saccharide ring are taken together to form a cyclic acetal protecting group. In some embodiments, two -ORX attached to adjacent carbon atoms on a saccharide ring are taken together to form a cyclic ketal protecting group.
[00100] In certain embodiments, each R~ is independently hydrogen. In certain embodiments, each Rx, is independently an optionally substituted 6-10-membered aryl group. In 39 of 205 certain embodiments, each R"' is independently an optionally substituted Ci_6 aliphatic group. In certain embodiments, each R"' is independently an optionally substituted Ci_6 heteroaliphatic group having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur. In some embodiments, two R"' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
[00101] In some embodiments, all Rx are hydrogen.
[00102] In certain embodiments, R' is a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
R' Rd Ro O O
a b Ra Rb d wherein each of R , Ra, Rb, Rc, Rd, a, b, c, and d is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00103] In some embodiments, a is 0. In some embodiments, a is 1.
[00104] In some embodiments, b is 0. In some embodiments, b is 1. In some embodiments, b is 2.
[00105] In some embodiments, c is 0. In some embodiments, c is 1. In some embodiments, c is 2.
[00106] In certain embodiments, the sum of b and c is 1. In certain embodiments, the sum of b and c is 2.
[00107] In certain embodiments, d is an integer from 1-7. In some embodiments, d is an integer from 1-5. In some embodiments, d is an integer from 1-4. In some embodiments, d is an integer from 1-2.
[00108] In certain embodiments, each d-bracketed structure is the same. In certain embodiments, each d-bracketed structure is different. In certain embodiments, two or more d-bracketed structures are the same.
[00109] In some embodiments, one or more d-bracketed structures is a furanose moiety.
In some embodiments, one or more d-bracketed structure is a pyranose moiety.

40 of 205
[00110] In some embodiments, R is hydrogen. In some embodiments, R is an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates. In other embodiments, R
is an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl and Ci_io aliphatic.
[00111] In some embodiments, each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is hydrogen. In some embodiments, each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is -OH. In some embodiments, each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is independently -OR. In some embodiments, each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is independently -ORX. In some embodiments, each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is independently an optionally substituted Ci_io aliphatic group.
In some embodiments, each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is independently an optionally substituted CJ-6 heteroaliphatic group.
[00112] In some embodiments, each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is -CH2OH.
In some embodiments, each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is methyl.
[00113] As generally described above, in certain embodiments, R' is a carbohydrate domain. In some embodiments, R' is a monosaccharide. In some embodiments, R' is an oligosaccharide. In certain embodiments, each occurrence of R' is independently selected from the group consisting of:
RXORXOX RxO ORX
x O ORX O O O ORX
O O
RxO R5 X RxO R5 X

6 ~ 04 ORX ORX RXO
RXO ORX
RXORXO 0 ORX RxO ORX

O O
RxO R5 ORX RxO R5 ORX
01-1--7-0 ORx HO0 O OH p 0 O ORx RXO O ORX R O O ORX
ORX OH , or I ORX
[00114] In certain embodiments, R2 is hydrogen. In certain embodiments, R2 is halogen.
In certain embodiments, R2 is -OH. In certain embodiments, R2 is OR. In certain embodiments, 41 of 205 R2 is -OC(O)R4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -OC(O)OR4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -OC(O)NHR4. In certain embodiments, R2 is-OC(O)NRR4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -OC(O)SR4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)R4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NRC(O)R4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)OR4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)NHR4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)NRR4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -N(R4)2. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHR4. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NRR4. In some embodiments, R2 is N3.
[00115] In some embodiments, R2 is an optionally substituted group selected from CI-30 aliphatic. In some embodiments, R2 is an optionally substituted group selected from CI-20 aliphatic. In some embodiments, R2 is an optionally substituted group selected from C1-lo aliphatic.
[00116] In some embodiments, R2 is an optionally substituted group selected from CI-30 heteroaliphatic. In some embodiments, R2 is an optionally substituted group selected from CI-20 heteroaliphatic. In some embodiments, R2 is an optionally substituted group selected from CI-10 heteroaliphatic. In some embodiments, R2 is an optionally substituted group selected from C1_6 heteroaliphatic.
[00117] In some embodiments, R3 is hydrogen. In some embodiments, R3 is halogen. In some embodiments, R3 is -OH. In some embodiments, R3 is -OR. In some embodiments, R3 is -OR". In some embodiments, R3 is an optionally substituted C1-lo aliphatic group. In some embodiments, R3 is an optionally substituted CJ-6 heteroaliphatic group. In some embodiments, R3 is not hydrogen. In some embodiments, R3 is not -OH.
[00118] In some embodiments, R3 is -CH2OR. In some embodiments, R3 is -CH2OH.
In some embodiments, R3 is methyl. In some embodiments, R3 is not methyl. In some embodiments, R3 is CH2OR'.

X OR i0eR1
[00119] In some embodiments, R4 is Me Me 42 of 205
[00120] In some embodiments, X is -0-. In some embodiments, X is -NR-.In some OR O OR
Me Me embodiments, R4 is Me Me . In some embodiments, R4 HO,O OH

H

OH O
Me Me is Me Me HO,O OH
H
NN.,~ ,.0 OH
OH O OH
Me Me
[00121] In some embodiments, R4 is Me Me O
[00122] In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)R4; and R4 is p , wherein p is an integer from 0 to 12, inclusive. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)R4;
and R4 is O
~~'+ OH
p , wherein p is an integer from 0 to 12, inclusive. In certain embodiments, R2 is -Me 1+
NH
NHC(O)R4; and R4 is p Me wherein p is an integer from 0 to 12, inclusive. In certain Me N
embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)R4; and R4 is p Me, wherein p is an integer from 0 to 12, 'Ir inclusive. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)R4; and R4 is OH , wherein p is an integer from 0 to 12, inclusive. In certain embodiments, R2 is -NHC(O)R4; and R4 is 43 of 205 ~O\ Me P , wherein p is an integer from 1 to 12, inclusive. In certain embodiments, R2 is -Me H Me Me .0 "H
NHC(O)R4; and R4 is Me Me
[00123] In certain embodiments, two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
[00124] As described above, in certain embodiments, R4 is T-R'. In some embodiments, T
is a covalent bond or a bivalent CI-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, hydrocarbon chain, wherein one or two methylene units of T are optionally and independently replaced by -0-, -S-, -N(R)-, -C(O)-, -C(O)O-, -OC(O)-, -N(R)C(O)-, -C(O)N(R)-, -S(O), -S(O)2-, -N(R)S02-, or -SO2N(R)-. In certain embodiments, T is a covalent bond or a bivalent CI-16 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain. In certain embodiments, T is a covalent bond or a bivalent CI-12 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain. In certain embodiments, T is a covalent bond or a bivalent CJ-8 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain.
[00125] In certain embodiments, -T- is selected from the group consisting of sf 0/ ss's O;+z~ s' ~, OX 0 or
[00126] In some embodiments, Rz is hydrogen. In some embodiments, Rz is halogen. In certain embodiments, Rz is -NC(O)OR. In some embodiments, Rz is -OR. In some embodiments, Rz is -OR". In some embodiments, Rz is -OR'. In some embodiments, Rz is -NR2. In certain embodiments, Rz is an optionally substituted acyl group. In certain embodiments, Rz is an optionally substituted arylalkyl group. In certain embodiments, Rz is an optionally substituted heteroarylalkyl group. In certain embodiments, Rz is an optionally substituted CJ-6 aliphatic group. In certain embodiments, Rz is an optionally substituted 6-10-44 of 205 membered aryl group. In certain embodiments, Rz is an optionally substituted 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur group. In certain embodiments, Rz is an optionally substituted 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur.
[00127] In certain embodiments, Rz is a monosaccharide. In certain embodiments, Rz is an oligosaccharide.
[00128] In certain embodiments, Rz is methyl. In certain embodiments, Rz is 7--O~

. In certain embodiments, RZ is
[00129] In some embodiments, each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen.
In some embodiments, each occurrence of R is independently an optionally substituted acyl group. In some embodiments, each occurrence of R is independently an optionally substituted arylalkyl group. In some embodiments, each occurrence of R is independently an optionally substituted C7_12 arylalkyl group. In some embodiments, each occurrence of R is independently an optionally substituted 6-10-membered aryl group. In some embodiments, each occurrence of R is independently an optionally substituted CI-12 aliphatic group. In some embodiments, each occurrence of R is independently an optionally substituted CJ-6 aliphatic group. In some embodiments, each occurrence of R is independently an optionally substituted heteroaliphatic group having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur. In some embodiments, two R on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
[00130] In certain embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, Cl_lo aliphatic, CJ-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-1 0-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur. In certain embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently hydrogen. In 45 of 205 some embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently -OH. In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently -OR. In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently -OR". In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently an optionally substituted Ci_io aliphatic group. In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently an optionally substituted Ci_6 heteroaliphatic group.
[00131] In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently -CH2OR. In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently CH2OH. In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are independently methyl.
[00132] In some embodiments, each of R3, R5, and R6 is independently an optionally substituted Ci_io aliphatic group. In some embodiments, each of R3, R5, and R6 is independently methyl. In some embodiments, each of R3, R5, and R6 is independently -CH2OR.
In some embodiments, one or more of R3, R5, and R6 is -CH2OH. In some embodiments, each of R3, R5, and R6 is -CH2OH.
[00133] As described in further detail below, some materials used in the synthesis of compounds of formula I may be commerically available extracts derived from natural sources as mixtures of saponins. Such extracts may contain saccharide moieties attached to the C3-position of the triterpene that differ from those depicted in formula L Examples of saponins and prosapogenins that may be used according to the present invention include those derived from Glycyrrhizic acid, Hederasaponin C, (3-Aescin, Helianthoside 2, Ginsenoside Rd, and Saponinum album, to name but a few. All naturally-derived glycosylation variants of the C3 position of the triterpene core are contemplated by the present invention.
[00134] In some embodiments, Rs of formula I is a xylose moiety, thereby providing a compound of formula VII-a:

O Y-Z
Me M4eH

R O O)C O Me O X O OR0 H e R
0 H H Me XO R RX
XO
RXOMe RXO
VII-a 46 of 205 wherein each of R", RY, W, V, Y and Z is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00135] In some embodiments, Rs of formula I is a rhamnose moiety, thereby providing a compound of formula VII-b:

O Y-Z
Me Me H
R O O)C O Me H
RR O O O W H Me V "'Me OR" OR" O H Me R" O OR"
RxO
VII-b wherein each of R", RY, W, V, Y and Z is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00136] In some embodiments, the triterpene core of formula I bears a monosaccharide at position C3. In some embodiments, a monosaccharide-substituted compound is of formula VIII:
O -Z
Me Me H
RY(O)Q O Me H
RRXOO~\ :O
\O_R H H H Me V'eMe VIII
wherein each of R", RY, W, V, Y and Z is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00137] In some embodiments, the triterpene core of formula I bears an oligosaccharide at position C3. In some embodiments, oligosaccharide will contain rhamnose residues.
[00138] In certain embodiments, the triterpene core of formula I will bear disaccharides at position C3. In some embodiments, the disaccharide is galactose-glucuronic acid. In some embodiments, a disaccharide-substituted compound is of formula IX:

47 of 205 O Y-Z
Me M4eH
RXO O)C O
Me R"OO
e OR O H H H Me O
R" O OR"
R" O
IX
wherein each of R", RY, W, V, Y and Z is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00139] In some embodiments, the triterpene core of formula I bears no saccharide group at position C3, providing a compound of formula X:

Me Me H
Me H
HOL
W H Me V ''Me H H Me X
wherein each of W, V, Y and Z is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00140] Exemplary compounds of formula I are set forth in Table 1 below.
Table 1. Exemplary compounds of formula I

H Ph Bn0 OO
O OBn O
BnO p O OBn Et3Si_O'~\_\ OBn O O OBn O O Me Me H
Me OOAc Bn02C Me H
O Et SiO
BnO- 3 ~O O Me O
BnO O CHO H Me O IV Bn0 BnO OBn0 O H H Et3Si/ Me O~O
BnOSiEt3 Me Me BnO

48 of 205 H Ph Bn0 O 0 O OBn O
BnO Me O OBn OBn :Et3sloxo-;~OBn O O OBn O Me BnOZC Me Me Me H OAc O Et Si0 H
Et SiO 3~O Me O
E3t3Si0 O CHO H Me O 'Me Bn0 Et3SiO Et3SiO 0 0 H H Et3Si' Me O O
Et3SiO SiEt3 Me Me Et3SiO

HO HO OH
OOH
O
HO Me OOH
H
O OH Hp O OH
O O
Me Me H O H
HOZC O ~HH e H HN N ,O OH
-OHO
HHOp p O CMe HO T'Me O 0 OH Me 0 OH Me OH OH VC H H Me Me O
HO HO Me Me H HO OH
HO
O

O" '-OH

HO Me OOH
H
O O O OH
Me Me H 0 HOZC O Me H ;At Me HOBO HO O
HO O HO H Me HO 'Me 0 OH OH 0 0 H- H Me Me O
HOJ HO
OH HO OH
HO

49 of 205 HO HO OH
O OH

O Me OOH
H
O O
OH HO
M4eH O p HO2C Me Me HN
~l:
HO~o HO ~ O p O
HO O CHO H e 0 OH OH O O H H Me Me O
HO HO
OH HO OH
HO

Me Me pTBS,p Me pTBS,p Me BnOO O O OTBS
0- H Ph O O O Me O'S~O TBSO OTBS
O Me Me H
Bn Me H O OBn OTESO O O O BnOT! OBn TTESO TESO OTES 0 HCHOH M Me OO Me OO
O -/
TESO~~/~C TES Me Me TESO

Me Me pTBS,p Me OTBS,p Me BnOO ~OTBS
O O Q O Me OBn TBSO LOTBS
O Me Me H BnOj-OBn Bn0 Me H O-/~v-/
TESO OTE88 O Me L_ ~ p O O OBn TESO TESO OTES O HCHOH TES' OMe Me OO Me O
TESO\ TES Me 'Me TESO~

50 of 205 ~
HN" i0 e O O HO OH HO p OH
O
HO 0 Me M4eH OHOHO 0 0 OH O H
Me HBO H 0 O O HO Me HO p CHO H e HO OH H H Me O
HOVH
HO

Me Me O HO Me O HO e H N H

OH
O O O OHO OH HO p OH HO O
HO O Me Me H O OH
OHHO OH
Me O--44Vft/
HO~o HO O O L H Op Me HO ,,Oi~~ p CHO H Me HO "Me HO OH H H Me O
HOVH
HO

HO
O
HN OH
O
~~ 6H
HO OH H
O OO HOpOH
O
Me Me M4eH

p O 0 0 OH OH
-'- .
OO H O O O HO Me H
HO p CHO H e HO OHO H H Me HOVH
HO

51 of 205 HO
O
~' `' OH
HN _ M1 ~
2o~ HO OH OH

O Me M4eH
HO Me HO O
H e HO p HO OH O H CHH H Me HOVH
HO

HO
O
~, OH
HN_ 11 ,O
HO OH OH
O O O
O Me M4eH OH
HO Me HO OH O O O
HC O O He OH
HO OH O H CHO H Me HOV H HO
O
HO

HO
O
OH
HN" r'I11 ,O
HO pH OH
O O O' O
O Me M4eH
HO O Me OH
O O O OH

OHO %S~- O O CHO H e HO Me HO OH O H H Me HOH
HOB' 52 of 205 HO
O
OH
HN" M1~ O
HO OH OH
O O~ O
Me M 4eH OHH?- 2- 0 OH H
Me O,0 0 HO HO Me OHC H e Me HO
O
) l OH
HN 1~ , O
HO OH OH
O O~ O
OH
HO O ~_O Me Me M\ H H O O O O O OH
HO~~~~O~~H 0~~ ~O L HO Me HO~ 0 H Me HO "'Me HO OH O Me HOV OH
OH
HO

HO
OH

HO Me OOH
H
O OH HO,O OH
O O
Me Me H O H
HOZC Me H HN N ,,O OH
O HO~~O H O OH O O HCHO M. H Me O 'Me 0 O OH 0 OH
O Me Me O Me Me HO HO HO OH Me Me O H
HO

53 of 205 HO HO OH
O OH
O
HO Me OOH
H
O OH HO O OH
O O
Me Me H O H
HO2C O Me H HN O OH
O HO
HOO O CHO H Me O ''Me OH OH O OH
OH OH O O H H Me 'Me 'Me HO H Me Me HO

HO
OH
Me OOH

H
O OH HO.O OH
O O
Me Me H O H
HO2C Me H HN N ,,O OH
O HO~O
HHO O CHO H Me HO 'Me OH O OH O OH
OH OH O O H H Me 'Me Me HO H Me Me HO

HO
OH

H
t,7-- Me OOH
O O HOH
Me M e HH 0 HO2C Me H Me HO O
HO O CHOH Me HO '' Me Me 0 O H H Me O
OH VOH
HO H HO HO
OH
HO

54 of 205 HO HO O OH

O OH

HO Me OOH
H
O O O OH
Me M4eH O
HO2C O Me HN Me HOBO HOO OH
HO`OH OH O HCHOH e e 0 O
HO OH
HO

HO
OH
O Me OOH

H

Me M e HH 0 HO2C Me H Me HO oH0 L OH
HO O CHO H Me HO ''Me 0 OH OO~H//O~~O H H Me HO\, CH
HO

~O ~O
HN" 'Mio 'OH

0 O HO OH HO p OH
O

HO O Me Me R;:i p O p O O OH OH
HOo H O O O OO Me HO p HO e HO OH H Me H O
HOVH
HO

55 of 205 HNlk OMe O O HO OH HOp OH
O

HO O Me Me M\ H p O p 0 0 OH OH
,0 H O O O H HO Me HO
HO HO OH p HCHOH H Me HO "'Me p Me HO OH
HO

Me,, Me H Me Me H Me O H H
~
HN O H H

O O HO OH HO OH
O
HO O Me M4eH p O p p O
Me OH~HO-o H p O HO Me HO p CHe HO OHO H H Me HOVH
HO

HN,kl~10--~O---iO-Me HO OH

O Me M4eH OH
HO Me O O O O OH
HO~o H O O HO Me HO p CH O e HO OH p H H Me HOVH
HO

56 of 205 OH
HO
O HO O
OH
HN O
HO OH

O Me Me H OH
HO Me OHIHO O OH
HO'~OH O O H HO Me HO CHO H Me HO "'Me O. p HO O H H Me H

BnO OBn O O
O O
j4e e OBn H O O O OBn TESO OTESOO O O Op Me TES CHO Me O 'Me TESO OTESO O H H TES Me Me Me TESO 1~ OTES
TESO

O O
O O
O Me Me H
Bn0 Me O
H ' OBn TESO OTESOO O O Op Me TES CHO Me O "Me TESO OTESO O H H TES Me Me I'Me TESO 1~ OTES
TESO

57 of 205 N3 H Ph BnOJ OBn o O Me Me M4eH
O Bn0 OOBnBnO M , 00B n TESO~OTE O O 0 00 Me TES:) OTES O HCHOH H e TESO O TES Me Me L'Me TESO OTES
TESO
[00141] In certain embodiments, a compound of formula I is not selected from:
58 of 205 O OH
Me Me H
BnO2;C O Me H
O Et3SiO-/~' O
BnO
Bn0 CHO H Me O "'Me BnO OBn O O H H Et3Si ' Me BnO OSiEt3 O OH
BnO Me M4eH
BnO2C Me BnO O HO_ O p O
Bn0 O CHe BnO OBn O O H H H Me BnO OH
O Oallyl BnO Me Me H
BnO2C O Me H
BnO- O Et3SiO_~~; /O
Bn BnO O CHO H Me O "'Me BnO OBn O O H H Et3Si ' Me Bn0 OSiEt3 O Oallyl BnO Me Me H
BnO2C Me H
BnO O H O O_~p BnO CHO H Me HO "'Me BnO OBn O O H H Me BnO OH
0 Oallyl BnO Me M4eH
HO2C Me Bn O O HO_::; O /p Bn0 O ' \ CHO e BnO OBn O 0 H H Me BnO OH
O Oallyl BnO Me M4eH

McO2C Me Bn0 O AcO_' ~~ ,p Bn0 O 0 CHO e BnO OBn O O H H Me BnO O
B OBz nO

59 of 205 0 OMe O Me M4eH
MeO Me AcO B CHO H BnO e BnO BnO OBn O O H H Me BnO OBz BnO
0 OMe Me M4eH
MeO Me cO p BzO
O CHO H e BZO BzO OBnO O H H Me BnO OBz BnO
[00142] It will be appreciated that it is not an object of the present invention to claim compounds disclosed in the prior art that are the result of isolation or degradation studies on naturally-occurring prosapongenins or saponins.
[00143] As described above for compounds of formula I, in some embodiments, Y
is -0-;
Z is a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

RIO

wherein each occurrence of R1 is R' or a carbohydrate domain comprising furanose or pyranose moieties; and R2 is NHC(O)R4.
[00144] Thus, according to one aspect, provided compounds are of formula II:
60 of 205 RxO
OR' O
X R5 p ORX

0 OR' O O O Ra M4eH O
O
Ry(O)C0 Me Me Ri 4 R5O- O HNyR
We ORX O H H Me 0 O
RXO pRX
RXO
II
wherein each of R', R3, R4, Rs, R", Rs, R37, V, and W is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00145] In some embodiments, provided compounds are of formula 11-a:
RxO R5 ORS
e H O
O 0 tw- RM

RY(O)C Me Me R5O-4 O H HNy W H Me V ''Me H Me O

R H
RxO pRX
RXO
II-a wherein each of R', R3, R4, Rs, Rs, R37, V, and W is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00146] In some embodiments, provided compounds are of formula II-b:
61 of 205 Me Me H RI O
RY(O)C Me RIO
RO 4 O PH HNyR4 0 W Me V "'Me H Me 0 ORXO H
RXO ORX
RXO
11-b wherein each of R', R3, R4, Rs, RX, Rs, RY, V, and W is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00147] As described above for compounds of formula I, in some embodiments, Y
is -0-;
and Z is a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

+ -7~ ~O R 3 RHO I

wherein each occurrence of R1 is R" or a carbohydrate domain comprising furanose or pyranose moieties.
[00148] Thus, according to one aspect, provided compounds are of formula III, III-a, III-b, III-c, III-d, III-e, III-f, or III-g:
RxO R5 Me H 0-Ry(O)C Me Me \ Rz RRs~0\ 0 H Oki 0 W H Me V"'Me ORX 0 H H Me RxO ORX

RxO
III
62 of 205 RXO

O
ROO R5 pORX

Me M4eH O
RY(O)C M e R2 RsO % OR1 O W e ORXO H H Me RXO pRX

RXO
111-a RXp R5 R'O O O p R3 ORX
Me H O
RY(O)C Me Me R2 RSOOJ-~ O H OR1 0 W Me V "'Me ORX p H H Me RXO pRX

RxO
III-b RxO R5 RXO O ORX
O O p R3 ORX
Me H 0 RXO RY(O)Q O Me Me H 2 Rsp 0 W H Me V "'Me R6 O

ORX O H H Me RXO RXO
RXp OR
pRX X
RxO
III-c 63 of 205 RXO
OR' O
ROO R5 pORX
OR' Me M4eH O
RY(O)C M e R2 RXp O O
RSO/`OO
O W e R6 O
X H H Me RXp ORO RXO
RXO pRX ORX
RXO
III-d RxO R5 Me Me H O
RY(O)C Me R2 RSOO
0 W Me V "'Me R6 O
X H H Me RXp OR O RXO
RXp pRX ORX
RXO
III-e 64 of 205 RxO
OR' O
RxO R5 OR
O O OR
RRO O OR
O O 4 O R3 OR`
Me H O
RY(O)C O Me Me R2 X ~-N O RO ~0 H ORS
R R 0 0 O W H Me V "'Me OR" ORX H H Me O
RxO ORx RxO
III-f RxO

OR' O

RxO R5 OR
O 0 OR"
O R OR"
O O 0 Rs OR`
M4eH O
R O RY(O)C 0 Me Me R0 2 X O
RR9O/0 O W e R6 O
OR OR 0 H H Me RXO RXO
RXO ORX OR"
RxO
III-g wherein each of R', R2, R3, R5, R6, R", Rs, R5', V, and W is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00149] As described above for compounds of formula I, in certain embodiments, each occurrence of Rx is independently a suitable hydroxyl protecting group; Y is CH2, -0-, -NR-, or -NH-; Z is hydrogen; a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group 65 of 205 consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, and heteroaryl. Thus, according to another aspect, provided compounds are of formula IV:
O
Me Me H
RY(0)Q Me H
RRSOO_::O O
W Me V "'Me ORx O H H Me RxO ORX

RxO
IV
wherein:
is a single or double bond;
Yis hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR, OH, NR2, NR3+, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;
RX,OYORx' W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2ORX, or -C(O)RY;
V is hydrogen or -OR;
RY is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;

RxO RRXO O \ RXO

RS is ~ ' or RXOMe each occurrence of R~ is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1_6 aliphatic, or Ci_6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two RX' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, CI-12 aliphatic, or CI-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

66 of 205 each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group.
[00150] In some embodiments, at least one occurrence of R" is an oxygen protecting group. In some embodiments, at least two occurrences of R" is an oxygen protecting group. In some embodiments, at least three occurrences of R" is an oxygen protecting group. In some embodiments, at least four occurrences of R" is an oxygen protecting group. In some embodiments, all R" are an oxygen protecting group. In some embodiments, each occurrence of R" is independently an oxygen protecting group. In certain embodiments, all R"
oxygen protecting groups are the same. In some embodiments, at least one R" oxygen protecting group is different from the other Rx oxygen protecting groups.
[00151] In some embodiments, Yis not -OMe. In some embodiments, Yis not -OH.
In some embodiments, Yis not -Oallyl. In some embodiments, Yis not -OH or -OMe if all R"
groups are simultaneously hydrogen or if at least four R" groups are simultaneously methyl.
[00152] In certain embodiments, at least one Rx group is not hydrogen. In certain embodiments, at least one Rx group is not methyl. In certain embodiments, at least one R" group is not hydrogen or methyl. In certain embodiments, no R" groups are hydrogen.
In certain embodiments, no Rx groups are methyl. In certain embodiments, no RX groups are hydrogen or methyl.
[00153] In certain embodiments, provided compounds are of formula IV-b:
O OH
Me Me H
R O RY(O)C Me H
s _ O
R O O CHO Me RXO ''Me ORX O H H Me RXO ORX

RXO
IV-b
[00154] Exemplary compounds of formula IV are set forth in Table la below.
67 of 205 Table Ia. Exemplary compounds of formula IV
O OH
Me Me H
BnO2C Me H
-o BnO-~J_~ _O
BnO~:
Bno O CHO H Me BnO Me E; le BnO OBnO O H H
BnOViBn BnO

O OH
Me Me H
HO2C O Me H
Et3SiO0 Et3Si0 O Et OO O HCHOH Me O ''Me Et3Si Me Et3SiO 3 V_C
Et3SiOSiEt3 Et3SiOMe Et3Si0 OH
Me Me H
Bn02C Me H
Et3SiO~_~ 0 1 Et3SiO O Et SOiO 0 HCHOH H Me O ''Me s ~0 Et3Si Me Et3Si0 Et3SiOS
OSiEt3 Et3SiO Me Et3SiO

O OH
Me Me H
BnO2C Me Et SiO H
Et Si0'ty O ~O O
-144 ~t3SiO O CHO H Me 0 'Me Et3SiO Et3SiO O O H H Et3Si' Me Et3SiO~~/ SiEt3 Et3SiO , or Me Me H
HO2C Me 3Si0 O H
Et SiO-I-O Et t3Si0 CHO H Me O 'Me Et3SiO Et3SiO O O H H Et3Si' Me Et3SiO SiEt3 Et3SiO
Synthesis of Compounds
[00155] Quil-A (Accurate Chemical and Scientific Corporation, Westbury, NY) is a commerically available semi-purified extract from Quillaja saonaria which compries a mixture of at least 50 distinct saponin species (van Setten, D. C.; Vandewerken, G.;
Zomer, G.; Kersten, G. F. A. Rapid Commun. Mass Spectrom. 1995, 9, 660-666). Many of said saponin species 68 of 205 include a triterpene-trisaccharide substructure as found in immunologically-active Quillajasaponins such as QS-21 and QS-7:
O 0+
Me M4eH
HOZC Me O ~O
HO'tv0 H
HO O CHO e OH OH0 O H H Me HOB " H
HO
[00156] It has been demonstrated (Guo, S.; Kenne, L.; Lundgren, L. N.;
Ronnberg, B.;
Sundquist, B. G. Phytochemistry, 1998, 48, 175-180) that exposure of saponin mixtures to base hydrolysis affords a mixure enriched with three prosapongenins A, B, and C:
O OH O OH
Me M4eH Me Me H
H02 C Me H02C Me H
HOBHOLO O HO O
OO
CHO H e HO / CHO H Me HO 'Me H
O\ H H Me HO O O H H Me HO OH HOMeHO\OH
HO HO
A B

O OH
Me Me H
HO2C O Me H
Hol O e H OH HCHOH H Me HOMeMe O
HO OH
HO
C
[00157] However, further use of this semi-pure hydrolyzed mixture of prosapongenins is hindered by the fact that prosapongenins A and B, which differ only by an a-L-Rha vs. (3-D-Xyl residue, are inseperable by silica gel chromatography.
[00158] Other work has described isolation of highly pure or semi-pure prosapogenins and saponins (W000/09075, U.S. Patent Nos. 6,231,859, 5,977,081, 6,080,725, 6,262,029; Higuchi, et at., Phytochemistry 1987, 26, 229-235; Brown, F., Haahein, LR (eds), Dev Biol Stand., vol.
92: Brown, F. and Haahein, LR., Karger, Basel:1998, pp 41-47; Kensil, 1991, supra; van Setten, supra). However, these procedures are not efficient in terms of cost and labor, often requiring several rounds of silica gel and/or HPLC purification in order to isolate the desired products.
Furthermore, there is batch variability between commercially available QS
samples such that 69 of 205 some batches contain no saponins with rhamnose-containing branched trisaccharides. None of the previously described isolation or degradation studies provides efficient access to pure prosapogenins or sapogenins. For example, U.S. Patent No. 6,231,859 describes the isolation of 98% pure QS-21 following one silica gel chromatography and three or four additional rounds of HPLC run in sequence. The final yield of QS-21 was 59 mg from 20 g of Quillaja saponaria extract (see Examples 1 and 2). A similar procedure for the isolation of QS-7 yielded 7 mg of purified QS-7 (final purity not reported) from a 20 g Quillaja saponaria extract (see Examples 1 and 4). Such yields and purity are not sufficient for large scale production of pharmaceutical grade adjuvants.
[00159] In one aspect of the present invention, Applicant has unexpectedly found a strategy that allows for the facile separation of derivatized prosapogenins A
and B via silica gel chromatography. In one aspect, the hydroxyl groups on prosapogenins A and B
are derivatized with a suitable protecting group, as described herein, to afford derivatives that are separable by silica gel chromatography. In some embodiments, all hydroxyl groups are derivatized with the same protecting group. In other embodiments, different hydroxyl groups bear different protecting groups. In certain embodiments, the hydroxyl-protected prosapogenin A and B
derivatives also have a protecting group on one or both of their carboxylic acid groups.
[00160] In certain embodiments, poly(silylation) of prosapogenins A and B, wherein all hydroxyl groups are converted to silyl ethers, gives a mixture of poly(silylated) diacid prosapogenins A and B that are easily separable via silica gel chromatography.
In some embodiments, poly(silylation) is used to afford nonakis(trialkylsilyl) ethers of prosapogenins A
and B. In some embodiments, poly(silylation) is used to afford nonakis(triethylsilyl) ethers of prosapogenins A and B. In some embodiments, poly(silylation) is used to afford nonakis(trimethylsilyl) ethers of prosapogenins A and B.
[00161] In other embodiments, the hydroxyl groups on prosapogenins A and B are derivatized as poly(benzyl) ethers to give a mixture of poly(benzyl) diacids of prosapogenins A
and B that are easily seperable via silica gel chromatography. In some embodiments, poly(benzyl) etherification is used to afford nonakis(benzyl) ethers of prosapogenins A and B.
[00162] One of ordinary skill will appreciate that a number of suitable protecting groups may be used, and that one or both carboxylic acid groups may optionally be protected as well. In 70 of 205 certain embodiments, the glucoronic acid group is selectively protected prior to derivitizing the hydroxyl groups of prosapogenins A and B. In some embodiments, the glucoronic acid group is selectively protected subsequent to derivitizing the hydroxyl groups of prosapogenins A and B.
[00163] Batch variability of commerically available Quillaja saponaria extracts may result in hydrolyzed saponin mixtures containing prosapogenins other than A, B, and C. In certain embodiments, the hydrolyzed saponin mixture subjected to the described protecting group strategy will be an enriched mixture of prosapogenins A and B. In some embodiments, the saponin mixture will contain one or more other prosapogenins such as prosapogenin C. In certain embodiments, a preliminary round of chromatography is used to render the saponin mixture enriched in prosapogenins A and B.
[00164] Other prosapongenins may be subjected to base hydrolysis and the protecting group strategies described above and herein. Examples of saponins that may be derivatized with protecting groups according to the present invention include Glycyrrhizic acid, Hederasaponin C, (3-Aescin, Helianthoside 2, Ginsenoside Rd, and Saponinum album, to name but a few.
[00165] In some embodiments, the mixture of prosapogenins will contain rhamnose residues. In some embodiments, the mixture of prosapogenins will not contain rhamnose residues. In some embodiments, the mixture of prosapogenins will be derived from Gypsoside A.
[00166] In certain embodiments, the mixture of prosapogenins will contain disaccharides.
In some embodiments, the disaccharide is galactose-glucuronic acid.
[00167] As described herein, prosapogenins bearing protecting groups in accordance with the present invention may be separated and isolated from one another by suitable physical means. The term "separated by suitable physical means" refers to methods of separating mixtures of prosapogenins or saponins. Such methods are well known in the art and include preferential crystallization, chromatography, and trituration, among others.
One of ordinary skill in the art will recognize that such methods may allow for the separation and isolation of both major and minor constituents.
[00168] In some embodiments, suitable protecting groups will render provided compounds crystalline. In certain embodiments, preferential crystallization is used to separate provided compounds.

71 of 205
[00169] It will be appreciated that chromatography steps aimed at separating derivatives of prosapogenins A and B may be carried out according to methods known in the art. In certain embodiments, chromatography is carried out on derivatives of prosapogenins A
and B wherein all hydroxyl groups bear a suitable protecting group. In some embodiments, chromatography is carried out on poly(benzyl) diacids of prosapogenins A and B. In some embodiments, chromatography is carried out on poly(silyl) ether diacids of prosapogenins A
and B. In some embodiments, chromatography is carried out on poly(benzyl) ethers of prosapogenins A and B
wherein one or both carboxylic acid groups bears a protecting group. In some embodiments, chromatography is carried out on poly(silyl) ethers of prosapogenins A and B
wherein one or both carboxylic acid groups bears a protecting group.
[00170] In certain embodiments, the chromatography is gravity silica gel chromatography.
In certain embodiments, the chromatography is flash silica gel chromatography.
In certain embodiments, the chromatography is gravity alumina gel chromatography. In certain embodiments, the chromatography is flash alumina gel chromatography. In certain embodiments, the chromatography is high pressure liquid chromatography (HPLC).
[00171] In some embodiments, separation by suitable physical means yields provides prosapogenin compounds of >70% purity. In some embodiments, separation by suitable physical means yields provides prosapogenin compounds of >80% purity. In some embodiments, separation by suitable physical means yields provides prosapogenin compounds of >90% purity. In some embodiments, separation by suitable physical means yields provides prosapogenin compounds of >95% purity. In some embodiments, separation by suitable physical means yields provides prosapogenin compounds of >98% purity. In some embodiments, separation by suitable physical means yields provides prosapogenin compounds of >99% purity. In some embodiments, separation by suitable physical means yields provides prosapogenin compounds of >99.5% purity. In some embodiments, separation by suitable physical means yields provides prosapogenin compounds of >99.9% purity.
[00172] In certain embodiments, provided compounds of formula I have >80%
purity. In some embodiments, provided compounds of formula I have >90% purity. In some embodiments, provided compounds of formula I have >95% purity. In some embodiments, provided compounds of formula I have >98% purity. In some embodiments, provided 72 of 205 compounds of formula I have >99% purity. In some embodiments, provided compounds of formula I have >99.5% purity. In some embodiments, provided compounds of formula I have >99.9% purity.
[00173] Thus, according to another aspect, the invention provides a method of using protecting groups to isolate prosapogenins, the method comprising the steps of:
(a) providing a mixture of prosapogenins of formula IV-a:
O
Me Me H
RY(O)C O Me H

H Me V ."'Me Rs1O O~ H W H Me OH O
HO OH
HO
IV-a wherein:
is a single or double bond;
Yis hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR, OH, NR2, NR3+, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;
R`'OYOW
W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2OR", or -C(O)RY;
V is hydrogen or -OR;
RY is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;

HO
HO-X;HO
Rs1 is OH or HOMe each occurrence of R" is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, CJ-6 aliphatic, or Ci_6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R"' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

73 of 205 each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, Ci_6 aliphatic, or Ci_6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;
(b) treating said compound of formula IV-a under suitable conditions to form a mixture of prosapogenins of formula IV:
O
Me Me H
RY(O)Q Me H
RRSOO/-` OO
W Me v ,Me OR" H Me RxO ORx RO
IV
wherein each of RY, Y', V, and W is as defined for compounds of formula IV-a, Rs is as defined for compounds of formula I, and each occurrence of R" is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;
and (c) obtaining said compound IV by suitable physical means.
[00174] As described above, the present invention provides methods of preparing compounds of formula L In some embodiments, the R" and RY groups of provided compounds are suitable protecting groups. Without wishing to be bound by any particular theory, it is believed that the presence of said protecting groups on provided compounds of formula IV is useful in the reaction of compounds of formula IV with a compound of formula V
to form a compound of formula L As depicted below in Scheme 1, a compound of formula IV
may be reacted under suitable conditions with a compound of formula V to provide a compound of formula I.

74 of 205 Scheme 1 Y' Me Me H
R O RY(O)Q O Me H LG-Z
O ~~0 V
RR O O- \O W H H Me V "'Me Do-OR ORX O H Me S-1 RxO ORx IV

Me Me H
R O RY(O)Q Me H

RRO O O W H H Me V Me e OR OR" O H
RxO ORx I
RO

wherein each of -, R", RY, V, and W is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein;
Yis hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR, OH, NR2, NR3+, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;
Z is hydrogen; a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, and heteroaryl; or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

- O O R3 R'O O R3 R~ O R
R2 or OR1 wherein:
each occurrence of R1 is R" or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
75 of 205 R' Rd Ro O
a b Ra Rb d wherein:
each occurrence of a, b, and c is independently 0, 1, or 2;
d is an integer from 1-5, wherein each d bracketed structure may be the same or different; with the proviso that the d bracketed structure represents a furanose or pyranose moiety, and the sum of b and c is 1 or 2;
R is hydrogen, an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates; or an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, CI-10 aliphatic, CI-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of Ra, Rb, R , and Rd is independently hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR", NR2, NHCOR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, Ci_io aliphatic, Ci_6 heteroaliphatic, 6-1 0-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
[00175] One of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that provided compounds can be subjected to reductive conditions (i.e., LiAlH4, NaBH4, A1H3, NaBH3(OAc), Zn(BH4)2, Et3SiH, and others described in March, supra) to transform the aldehyde moiety into an alcohol or methyl group. Provided compounds can also be subjected to oxidative conditions (i.e., Mn04-, chromic acid, bromine, Oxone , silver oxide, and others described in March, supra) to transform the aldehyde moiety into a carboxyl group. Such hydroxyl or carboxyl groups can be protected with suitable protecting groups as defined above and herein.

76 of 205 R" 'OOR"
[00176] Thus, in certain embodiments, W is Me, -CHO, T , -CH2OR', or -C(O)ORY. In certain embodiments, W is methyl. In other embodiments, W is -CHO. In certain embodiments, W is -CH2OR". In other embodiments, W is -C(O)ORY. In some embodiments, W is -CH2OH. In other embodiments, W is -CH2OBn. In other embodiments, W is -CH2OSiEt3.
In certain embodiments, W is -C(O)OH. In other embodiments, W is -C(O)OBn.
[00177] In certain embodiments, V is -OR". In some embodiments, V is -OH. In some embodiments, V is hydrogen.
[00178] As defined above, -- represents a single or double bond. It will be appreciated that compounds of formula IV can be subjected to hydrogenation conditions (i.e., Raney-Ni, Pd/C, NaBH4, reduced nickel, Adams' catalyst, zinc oxide, Wilkinson's catalyst, and others described in March, supra) that reduce the double bond to a single bond.
[00179] It will be appreciated that the C28 carboxyl group may be transformed into other carbonyl functional groups. In some embodiments, the carboxyl group is reduced to an aldehyde. In other embodiments, the carboxyl group is converted into a Weinreb amide. In other embodiments, the carboxyl group is converted into an amide. In other embodiments, the carboxyl group is converted into an ester.
[00180] As defined above, Y is CH2, -0-, -NR-, or -NH-. In certain embodiments, Y is CH2. In certain embodiments, Y is -0-. In other embodiments, Y is -NR-. In some embodiments, Y is -NH-.
[00181] The present invention encompasses the recognition that judicious selection of protecting groups on provided compounds of formula IV allows for the derivation of the -C(O)Y' group attached to C28. In certain embodiments, -C(O)Y' is a ketone. In other embodiments, -C(O)Y' is an amide. In some embodiments, -C(O)Y' is an ester.
[00182] The LG group of formula V is a suitable leaving group. One of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that a variety of suitable leaving groups LG can be used to facilitate the reaction described in step S-1, and all such suitable leaving groups are contemplated by the present invention. A suitable leaving group is a chemical group that is readily displaced by a desired incoming chemical moiety. Suitable leaving groups are well known in the art, e.g., see, March, supra. Such leaving groups include, but are not limited to, halogen, alkoxy, 77 of 205 sulphonyloxy, optionally substituted alkylsulphonyl, optionally substituted alkenylsulfonyl, optionally substituted arylsulfonyl, and diazonium moieties. Examples of some suitable leaving groups include chloro, iodo, bromo, fluoro, methanesulfonyl (mesyl), tosyl, triflate, nitro-phenylsulfonyl (nosyl), and bromo-phenylsulfonyl (brosyl). Additional leaving groups are described herein.
[00183] In certain embodiments, a compound of formula V is a monosacchide or oligosaccharide that may act as a glycosylation donor. Thus, according to another aspect of the invention, provided compounds are of formulae VI or VI':

Rl O R2 VI VI' wherein each of R', R2, and R3 is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein; and LG1 is a suitable leaving group.
[00184] As depicted in Scheme 2, a compound of formula IV may be reacted under suitable conditions with a compound of formula VI to give a compound of formula I-A:
Scheme 2 LG' Me H
RY02C Me Me H VI 0 RXO) 'O/O
0 W Me v "'Me 10 ORX 0 H H Me R`O ORX IV

Me H R1O
RY02~C Me Me RHO
RXSO0 O L H Rz 0 W Me V "'Me ORX 0 H H Me RXO ORX I-A
RXO
wherein each of =, R", RY, Rs, V, W, Y', Y, R', R2, R3, and LG1 is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.

78 of 205
[00185] The LG' group of compounds of formulae VI and VI' is a glycoside donor leaving group, as defined and described herein. One of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that a variety of suitable leaving groups LGi can be used to facilitate the reaction described, and all such suitable leaving groups are contemplated by the present invention.
[00186] In some embodiments, LG' is monovalent. In other embodiments, LGi is divalent. In certain embodiments, the LG group of formula V is halogen, thioalkyl, thioaryl, thioheteroaryl, thiocyano, O-acyl, orthoester, O-carbonate, S-carbonate, trichloroimidate, 4-pentenyl, phosphate, 0-sulfonyl, O-silyl, hydroxyl, diazirine, or arylseleno.
[00187] As described above, in certain embodiments the LG' group is halogen.
In some embodiments, LG' is Br. In some embodiments, LG' is Cl. In some embodiments, LGi is F.
[00188] In some embodiments, LG' is thioalkyl. In some embodiments, LG' is -SEt. In some embodiments, LG' is -SMe.
[00189] In some embodiments, LG' is thioaryl. In some embodiments, LG' is -SPh.
[00190] In some embodiments, LG' is thioheteroaryl. In some embodiments, LGi is N

thiopyridinyl (-SPy). In some embodiments, LGi is S . In some embodiments, Ph S
N`N
LGi is '" N-N
[00191] In some embodiments, LG' is O-acyl. In some embodiments, LG' is -OAc.
In some embodiments, LG' is -OC(O)CH2Br. In some embodiments, LGi is -OBz. In some embodiments, LG' is -OC(O)C6H4 p-NO2. In some embodiments, LGi is -OC(O)Py.
[00192] In some embodiments, the LGi group maybe taken together with another part of Z to form a cyclic moiety. In certain embodiments, the taking together of LGi with another part of Z forms an ortho ester or derivative thereof. In certain embodiments, the LGi group comprises a tent-butyl ortho ester. In some embodiments, the LGi group comprises a 1-cyanoethylidene. In some embodiments, the LG' group comprises a (p-methylphenyl)thioethylidene. In some embodiments, the LG1 group comprises an ethylthioethylidene. In some embodiments, the LG' group comprises an [N-(1-79 of 205 phenylethylidene)amino]oxyl-2,2-dimethylpropylidene. In some embodiments, the LG' group comprises a cyclic thiocarbonate. In some embodiments, the LGi group comprises a diazirine.
[00193] In some embodiments, LG' is O-carbonate. In some embodiments, LG' is 0-xanthate. In some embodiments, LG' is -OC(S)SMe. In some embodiments, LGi is O ^ S
0 S "

ON In some embodiments, LGi is \,-N. In some embodiments, LGi is -S
-S /~
SC(S)-OEt. In some embodiments, LGi isAN )
[00194] In certain embodiments, LG' is trichloroimidate. In some embodiments, LGi is -OC(NH)CC13.
[00195] In certain embodiments, LG' is 4-pentenyl. In some embodiments, LGi is -O(CH2)3CHCH2.
[00196] In certain embodiments, LGi comprises a phosphate. In some embodiments, LGi comprises a diphenyl phosphate. In some embodiments, LGi comprises a diphenylphosphineimidate. In some embodiments, LGi comprises a phosphoroamidate. In some embodiments, LG' comprises a phosphorodiamidimidothioate. In some embodiments, LGi comprises a dimethylphosphinothioate.
[00197] In certain embodiments, LG' is 0-sulfonyl. In some embodiments, LGi is -OTs.
In some embodiments, LG' is -OMs. In some embodiments, LG' is -OTf.
[00198] In some embodiments, LG' is O-silyl. In some embodiments, LG' is -OTMS. In some embodiments, LG' is -OSiEt3. In some embodiments, LG' is -OTBS.
[00199] In certain embodiments, LG' is hydroxyl.
[00200] In certain embodiments, LG' is a-linked compound of formula VI. In certain embodiments, LG' is (3-linked compound of formula VI.
[00201] In certain embodiments, LG' is n-alkenyl.
[00202] General methods and reagents for carrying out glycosylation reactions are described by Toshima, K. and Tatsuta, K., Chem. Rev. 1993, 93, 1503-1531, the entire contents of which is hereby incorporated by reference.
[00203] In certain embodiments, compounds of formula I are provided by conjugating an oligosaccharide of formulae VI or VI' with a compound of formula IV as described for step S-1.
80 of 205 In some embodiments, the entire oligosaccharide is prepared as a compound of formula VI prior to step S-1. In other embodiments, a monosaccharide of formula VI is conjugated in step S-1 to a compound of formula IV, and the resulting triterpene-saccharide conjugate is subjected to further glycosylation reactions to provide a compound of formula I. In some embodiments, protecting group strategies are employed that allow for selective glycosylation reactions to occur in the assembly of the final triterpene oligosaccharide compound of formula I.
[00204] Thus, in another aspect, the present invention provides compounds of formulae VI-1, VI-2, VI-3, VI-4, VI-5, VI-6, VI-7, VI-8, VI-9, VI-l0, and VI-11:

RxO ORX RXORXO 0 ORXuR"O O OR" 4O'LORX
RxO R5 uRX RXO R5 uRX
0 O ORx O O ORx LG O O R3 ORX LG O~R3 ORX

RX O RZ

RXO ORX RXO ORX

RXORXO 0 ORX RxO R5 4O_ORX
X
O

RxO R5 ORX O
O
ORx O Z
LG1, O R3 Rx0R6 O

81 of 205 RXO
ORx O RXO ORX
I~XO O ORX
RxO R5 ORX
O O O
ORX
LG~, RXO R5 ORX

O ORX
RXO LG'L
HNyR4 p) 3 O RXORZ

RXORXO p ORX RXO

RXO R5 ORX RXO R5 pRX
p ORX LG'L 3 LG~L 3 O~ RXp O RXp RXp R5 p pRX
ORX
LG1 O R3 LGti RXO O
RXO RXO
HNyR4 HNyR4 82 of 205 O ORI RIO O ORx ORI
ORI R2 OORx LG1ti O LG1= R O I

X
Rx0 RIO z wherein each of R2, R3, R4, Rs, R6, Rx, and LG' is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00205] In certain embodiments, compounds of formula VI are monosaccharide and D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are monosaccharide and L-fucosyl.
In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are monosaccharide and are not fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are monosaccharide and are not D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are monosaccharide and are not (3-D-fucosyl.
[00206] In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not (3-D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not a-D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are oligosaccharide, and the carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not fucosyl.
[00207] In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are optionally substituted monosaccharide and D-fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are optionally substituted monosaccharide and L-fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are optionally substituted monosaccharide and not fucosyl. In some embodiments, compounds of formula VI are optionally substituted monosaccharide and not (3-D-fucosyl.
[00208] Exemplary compounds of formula VI are set forth in Table 2.
83 of 205 Table 2. Exemplary compounds of formula VI
NH
C13Clk O

NH TBSO O Me CI3C O OOAc CI3C O TBSO Me BnOMe O
TBSO O Me pp O p TBSO
OAc Me Me H Ph H Ph BnO 0 0 BnO 0 0 O OBn 0 0 B n BnO Me BnO Me NHO 0 OBn OBn NHO 0 OBn OBn CI C O Et3Si0 OBn CI C 0 Et3Si0 OBn 3 0 Me OBn 3 pOH OBn OOAc OOAc Me O Me O
Bn0 BnO
Yp O
Meg Me MA" Me H Ph BnO 0 O
0 /t~~'-OBn Bn0 N3 OBn H Ph 0 p O p 0 BnO Me OBn NHO p OC(NH)CCI3 O
OBn O BnO OBn OBn C13C~ 0 0 O O
0OH O Me BnONHFmoc Me Me 84 of 205 Me Me TBS, Me TBS~ Me O O O O
OTBS
N3 BnOO O O
H Ph O Ono OBn O O Me OO TBSO
If- O OTBS
OC(NH)CCI3 O
OC(NH)CCI3 O O O O O OBnOBn O I O BOnO O OBn OBn O Me O Me Me Me Me I "Me Me Me TBS, Me TBS~
O O O OMe BnOO O O OTBS
O O Me TBSO
OBn OTBS
OC(NH)CCI3 BnO OBn O O
Q O O OBn O, O Me Me ~Me
[00209] In certain embodiments, the present compounds are generally prepared according to Scheme 3 set forth below:
Scheme 3 OH OR

Y S OO
Me Me Meg Me wherein each of R6 and R" is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00210] In some embodiments, the present compounds are generally prepared according to Scheme 4 set forth below:

85 of 205 Scheme 4 ORX ORX
HO '2;~ R3 S-3 RXO R3 HO
OH HOORX
wherein each of R3 and RX is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00211] In some embodiments, the present compounds are generally prepared according to Scheme 5 set forth below:
Scheme 5 ORX
X

X

RXO O + RXO O R3 X R6 O X R6 0 YO HO S-4' R O S-5 R O O
ORX O YO
MeoMe Me;, Me Meg Me wherein each of R3, R6, and RX is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00212] In some embodiments, the present compounds are generally prepared according to Scheme 6 set forth below:

86 of 205 Scheme 6 RXO RXO
ORX OH OR' HO 5 O HO McMe O McMe O
~O~ 5 Yp RXO'.~~.~ORX 10 pII~~R -O ORX S-7 OH S-6 p S-7 Ol~j -O
Me Me ORX ORX

RXO

O 4OR' 0 ORx OR' RXO R5 X
O p OR
RXO= O R3 ORS

OORX

Al RXO
O Me wherein each of Ri, R3, R5, R6, LGi, and R" is defined as described in classes and subclasses above and herein.
[00213] In each of the synthetic steps depicted in Schemes 3-6, one of ordinary skill will recognize that a variety of suitable protecting groups may be used. Orthogonal protecting group strategies are well known in the art and may be used to selectively protect and deprotect saccharide hydroxyl groups. It will be appreciated that a variety of suitable leaving groups LGi may also be employed, as described above, to carry out glycosylation step S-9.
[00214] In certain embodiments, step S-1 involves the addition of a nucleophile to a compound of formula IV. In some embodiments, the reaction between a compound of formula IV and a nucleophile is carried out using suitable esterification conditions.
The term "suitable esterification conditions," as used herein, refers to the catalyzed or uncatalyzed esterification or transesterification between an oxygen nucleophile and an ester or carboxylic acid. In some 87 of 205 embodiments, the conditions comprise the addition or one or more bases. In some embodiments, the base is an amine. In some embodiments, an additional promoter of esterification may be used such as DMAP or EDC.
[00215] In some embodiments, the reaction between a compound of formula IV and a nucleophile is carried out using suitable peptide bond forming conditions.
Suitable peptide coupling conditions are well known in the art and include those described in detail in Han et al., Tetrahedron, 60, 2447-67 (2004), the entirety of which is hereby incorporated by reference. In certain embodiments, the peptide coupling conditions include the addition of HOBt, DMAP, BOP, HBTU, HATU, BOMI, DCC, EDC, IBCF, or a combination thereof.
[00216] In some embodiments, the nucleophile is carbon-based, such as an alkyl metal species. In some embodiments, the nucleophile is a Grignard reagent. In some embodiments, the nucleophile is an organolithium. In some embodiments, the nucleophile is an organoborane.
In some embodiments, the nucleophile is an organotin. In some embodiments, the nucleophile is an enol.

Uses
[00217] Compounds of formulae I, II, III, or IV may be used as adjuvants or to enhance the cellular uptake of toxins. The inventive compounds may be particularly useful in the treatment or prevention of neoplasms or other proliferative diseases in vivo.
However, inventive compounds described above may also be used in vitro for research or clinical purposes.
Adjuvants
[00218] Most protein and glycoprotein antigens are poorly immunogenic or non-immunogenic when administered alone. Strong adaptive immune responses to such antigens often requires the use of adjuvants. Immune adjuvants are substances that, when administered to a subject, increase the immune response to an antigen or enhance certain activities of cells from the immune system. An adjuvant may also allow the use of a lower dose of antigen to achieve a useful immune response in a suject.
[00219] Common adjuvants include alum, Freund's adjuvant (an oil-in-water emulsion with dead mycobacteria), Freund's adjuvant with MDP (an oil-in-water emulsion with 88 of 205 muramyldipeptide, MDP, a constituent of mycobacteria), alum plus Bordetella pertussis (aluminum hydroxide gel with killed B. pertussis). Such adjuvants are thought to act by delaying the release of antigens and enhancing uptake by macrophages. Immune stimulatory complexes (ISCOMs) such as Quil-A (a Quillaja saponin extract) are open cage-like complexes typically with a diameter of about 40 nm that are built up by cholesterol, lipid, immunogen, and saponin.
ISCOMs deliver antigen to the cytosol, and have been demonstrated to promote antibody response and induction of T helper cell as well as cytotoxic T lymphocyte responses in a variety of experimental animal models.
[00220] Various studies have raised the concern of potential toxicity associated with saponin-based adjuvants. Fractionation experiments testing the major components of Quil-A
showed that QS-21 had low toxicity and QS-7 showed no lethality at the doses tested in CD-1 mice intradermally. QS-7 showed no hemolytic activity at levels up to 200 gg/mL of saponin (Kensil et al., 1991, supra).
[00221] In humans, QS-21 has displayed both local and systemic toxicity.
Maximum doses for healthy patients are typically <_ 50 g, and <_ 100 gg for cancer patients. As mentioned above, QS-7 has been found not only to possess significant stand-alone adjuvant activity, but also to induce remarkable synergistic immune response augmentation.
Unfortunately, QS-7 has proven difficult to isolate in clinically useful quantities.
[00222] The present invention encompasses the recognition that synthetic access to and structural modification of QS-7 and related Quillajasaponins may afford compounds with high adjuvant potency and low toxicity.

Enhanced uptake of toxins
[00223] Saponins have been shown to exhibit cell membrane-permeabilizing properties, and have been investigated for their therapeutic potential. In some cases, saponins have virtually no effect alone, but when used in combination with another drug will significantly amplify the effects of the other drug. One example of such a combination effect is with ginsenoside and cis-diaminedichloroplatinum(II) (Nakata, H., et al., Jpn J Cancer Res. 1998, 89, 733-40). Therefore, saponins have potential utility in combination therapies with antitumor drugs for cancer 89 of 205 treatment. Saponinum album from Gypsophilapaniculata L. has been described to enhance the cytotoxicity of a chimeric toxin in cell culture, even at nonpermeabilizing concentrations.
[00224] In certain embodiments, provided compounds may be used to enhance the uptake of other cytotoxic agents.

Vaccines
[00225] Compositions of the invention are useful as vaccines to induce active immunity towards antigens in subjects. Any animal that may experience the beneficial effects of the compositions of the present invention within the scope of subjects that may be treated. In some embodiments, the subjects are mammals. In some embodiments, the subjects are humans.
[00226] The vaccines of the present invention may be used to confer resistance to infection or cancer by either passive or active immunization. When the vaccines of the present invention are used to confer resistance through active immunization, a vaccine of the present invention is administered to an animal to elicit a protective immune response which either prevents or attenuates a proliferative or infectious disease. When the vaccines of the present invention are used to confer resistance to infection through passive immunization, the vaccine is provided to a host animal (e.g., human, dog, or mouse), and the antisera elicited by this vaccine is recovered and directly provided to a recipient suspected of having an infection or disease or exposed to a causative organism.
[00227] The present invention thus concerns and provides a means for preventing or attenuating a proliferative disease resulting from organisms or tumor cells which have antigens that are recognized and bound by antisera produced in response to the immunogenic polypeptides included in vaccines of the present invention. As used herein, a vaccine is said to prevent or attenuate a disease if its administration to an animal results either in the total or partial attenuation (i.e., suppression) of a symptom or condition of the disease, or in the total or partial immunity of the animal to the disease.
[00228] The administration of the vaccine (or the antisera which it elicits) may be for either a "prophylactic" or "therapeutic" purpose. When provided prophylactically, the vaccine(s) are provided in advance of any symptoms of proliferative disease. The prophylactic administration of the vaccine(s) serves to prevent or attenuate any subsequent presentation of the 90 of 205 disease. When provided therapeutically, the vaccine(s) is provided upon or after the detection of symptoms which indicate that an animal may be infected with a pathogen or have a certain cancer. The therapeutic administration of the vaccine(s) serves to attenuate any actual disease presentation. Thus, the vaccines may be provided either prior to the onset of disease proliferation (so as to prevent or attenuate an anticipated infection or cancer) or after the initiation of an actual proliferation.
[00229] Thus, in one aspect the present invention provides vaccines comprising one or more bacterial, viral, protozoal, or tumor-related antigens in combination with one or more inventive compounds. In some embodiments, the vaccine comprises a single bacterial, viral, protozoal, or tumor-related antigen in combination with one inventive compound. In some embodiments, the vaccine comprises two or more bacterial, viral, protozoal, or tumor-related antigens in combination with a single inventive compound. In some embodiments, the vaccine comprises a two or more bacterial, viral, protozoal, or tumor-related antigens in combination with two or more inventive compounds. In some embodiments, the vaccine comprises a single bacterial, viral, protozoal, or tumor-related antigens in combination with two or more inventive compounds.
[00230] In some embodiments, one or more antigens of provided vaccines are bacterial antigens. In certain embodiments, the bacterial antigens are antigens associated with a bacterium selected from the group consisting of Helicobacter pylori, Chlamydia pneumoniae, Chlamydia trachomatis, Ureaplasma urealyticum, Mycoplasmapneumoniae, Staphylococcus spp., Staphylococcus aureus, Streptococcus spp., Streptococcus pyogenes, Streptococcus pneumoniae, Streptococcus viridans, Enterococcusfaecalis, Neisseria meningitidis, Neisseria gonorrhoeae, Bacillus anthracis, Salmonella spp., Salmonella typhi, Vibrio cholera, Pasteurella pestis, Pseudomonas aeruginosa, Campylobacter spp., Campylobacterjejuni, Clostridium spp., Clostridium difficile, Mycobacterium spp., Mycobacterium tuberculosis, Treponema spp., Borrelia spp., Borrelia burgdorferi, Leptospria spp., Hemophilus ducreyi, Corynebacterium diphtheria, Bordetella pertussis, Bordetella parapertussis, Bordetella bronchiseptica, hemophilus influenza, Escherichia coli, Shigella spp., Erlichia spp., Rickettsia spp. and combinations thereof.

91 of 205
[00231] In certain embodiments, one or more antigens of provided vaccines are viral-associated antigens. In certain embodiments, the viral-associated antigens are antigens associated with a virus selected from the group consisting of influenza viruses, parainfluenza viruses, mumps virus, adenoviruses, respiratory syncytial virus, Epstein-Barr virus, rhinoviruses, polioviruses, coxsackieviruses, echo viruses, rubeola virus, rubella virus, varicell-zoster virus, herpes viruses, herpes simplex virus, parvoviruses, cytomegalovirus, hepatitis viruses, human papillomavirus, alphaviruses, flaviviruses, bunyaviruses, rabies virus, arenaviruses, filoviruses, HIV 1, HIV 2, HTLV- 1, HTLV-II, FeLV, bovine LV, FeIV, canine distemper virus, canine contagious hepatitis virus, feline calicivirus, feline rhinotracheitis virus, TGE virus, foot and mouth disease virus, and combinations thereof.
[00232] In certain embodiments, one or more antigens of provided vaccines are tumor-associated antigens. In some embodiments, the tumor-associated antigens are antigens selected from the group consisting of killed tumor cells and lysates thereof, MAGE- 1, MAGE-3 and peptide fragments thereof, human chorionic gonadotropin and peptide fragments thereof, carcinoembryonic antigen and peptide fragments thereof, alpha fetoprotein and peptide fragments thereof, pancreatic oncofetal antigen and peptide fragments thereof, MUC-1 and peptide fragments thereof, CA 125, CA 15-3, CA 19-9, CA 549, CA 195 and peptide fragments thereof, prostate-specific antigens and peptide fragments thereof, prostate-specific membrane antigen and peptide fragments thereof, squamous cell carcinoma antigen and peptide fragments thereof, ovarian cancer antigen and peptide fragments thereof, pancreas cancer associated antigen and peptide fragments thereof, Herl/neu and peptide fragments thereof;
gp-100 and peptide fragments thereof; mutant K-ras proteins and peptide fragments thereof; mutant p53 and peptide fragments thereof; truncated epidermal growth factor receptor, chimeric protein p210BCR-ABL KH-1, N3, GM I, GM2, GD2, GD3, Gb3, Globo-H, STn, Tn, Lewis", Lewisy, TF;
and mixtures thereof.
[00233] In certain embodiments, an antigen is covalently bound to a compound of formula I, II, III, or IV. In some embodiments, an antigen is not covalently bound to a compound of formula I, II, III, or IV.
[00234] One of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that vaccines may optionally include a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient or carrier. Thus, according to another aspect, 92 of 205 provided vaccines comprise one or more antigens that are optionally conjugated to a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient or carrier. In some embodiments, said one or more antigens are conjugated covalently to a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
In other embodiments, said one or more antigens are non-covalently associated with a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
[00235] As described above, adjuvants may be used to increase the immune response to an antigen. According to the invention, provided vaccines may be used invoke an immune response when administered to a subject. In certain embodiments, an immune response to an antigen may be potentiated by administering to a subject a provided vaccine in an effect amount to potentiate the immune response of said subject to said antigen.
[00236] As described above, provided compounds may be used in cancer vaccines as adjuvants in combination with tumor-associated antigens. In certain embodiments, said vaccines may be used in the treatment or prevention of neoplasms. In certain embodiments, the neoplasm is a benign neoplasm. In other embodiments, the neoplasm is a malignant neoplasm. Any cancer may be treated using compounds of the invention with an antigen.
[00237] In certain embodiments, the malignancy is a hematological malignancy.
Hematological malignancies are types of cancers that affect the blood, bone marrow, and/or lymph nodes. Examples of hematological malignancies that may be treated using compounds of formulae I, II, III, or IV include, but are not limited to, acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL), acute myelogenous leukemia (AML), chronic myelogenous leukemia (CML), chronic lymphocytic leukemia (CLL), hairy cell leukemia, Hodgkin's lymphoma, non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, cutaneous T-cell lymphoma (CTCL), peripheral T-cell lymphoma (PTCL), Mantle cell lymphoma, B-cell lymphoma, acute lymphoblastic T cell leukemia (T-ALL), acute promyelocytic leukemia, and multiple myeloma.
[00238] Other cancers besides hematological malignancies may also be treated using compounds of formulae I, II, III, or IV. In certain embodiments, the cancer is a solid tumor.
Exemplary cancers that may be treated using compounds of formulae I, II, III, or IV include colon cancer, lung cancer, bone cancer, pancreatic cancer, stomach cancer, esophageal cancer, skin cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, ovarian cancer, cervical cancer, uterine cancer, testicular cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, kidney cancer, neuroendocrine cancer, breast cancer, 93 of 205 gastric cancer, eye cancer, gallbladder cancer, laryngeal cancer, oral cancer, penile cancer, glandular tumors, rectal cancer, small intestine cancer, sarcoma, carcinoma, melanoma, urethral cancer, vaginal cancer, to name but a few.
[00239] In certain embodiments, compounds and pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention can be employed in combination therapies, that is, the compounds and pharmaceutical compositions can be administered concurrently with, prior to, or subsequent to, one or more other desired therapeutics or medical procedures. The particular combination of therapies (therapeutics or procedures) to employ in a combination regimen will take into account compatibility of the desired therapeutics and/or procedures and the desired therapeutic effect to be achieved. It will also be appreciated that the therapies employed may achieve a desired effect for the same disorder (for example, an inventive compound may be administered concurrently with another antiproliferative agent), or they may achieve different effects (e.g., control of any adverse effects).
[00240] For example, other therapies or anticancer agents that may be used in combination with the inventive anticancer agents of the present invention include surgery, radiotherapy (y-radiation, neutron beam radiotherapy, electron beam radiotherapy, proton therapy, brachytherapy, and systemic radioactive isotopes, to name a few), endocrine therapy, biologic response modifiers (interferons, interleukins, and tumor necrosis factor (TNF) to name a few), hyperthermia and cryotherapy, agents to attenuate any adverse effects (e.g., antiemetics), and other approved chemotherapeutic drugs, including, but not limited to, alkylating drugs (mechlorethamine, chlorambucil, Cyclophosphamide, Melphalan, Ifosfamide), antimetabolites (Methotrexate), purine antagonists and pyrimidine antagonists (6-Mercaptopurine, 5-Fluorouracil, Cytarabile, Gemcitabine), spindle poisons (Vinblastine, Vincristine, Vinorelbine, Paclitaxel), podophyllotoxins (Etoposide, Irinotecan, Topotecan), antibiotics (Doxorubicin, Bleomycin, Mitomycin), nitrosoureas (Carmustine, Lomustine), inorganic ions (Cisplatin, Carboplatin), enzymes (Asparaginase), and hormones (Tamoxifen, Leuprolide, Flutamide, and Megestrol), to name a few. Additionally, the present invention also encompasses the use of certain cytotoxic or anticancer agents currently in clinical trials and which may ultimately be approved by the FDA (including, but not limited to, epothilones and analogues thereof and geldanamycins and analogues thereof). For a more comprehensive discussion of updated cancer 94 of 205 therapies see, www.nci.nih.gov, a list of the FDA approved oncology drugs at www.fda.gov/cder/cancer/druglistframe.htm, and The Merck Manual, Seventeenth Ed. 1999, the entire contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference.
[00241] In another aspect, the invention provides a method of treating infectious disease in a subject comprising administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formulae I, II, III, or IV. In some embodiments, the infection is bacterial. In some embodiments, the infection is viral. In some embodiments, the infection is protozoal. In some embodiments, the subject is human.

Formulations
[00242] Inventive compounds may be combined with a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient to form a pharmaceutical composition. In certain embodiments, the pharmceutical composition includes a pharmaceutically acceptable amount of an inventive compound. The amount of active ingredient which can be combined with a carrier material to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the host being treated, and the particular mode of administration. The amount of active ingredient that can be combined with a carrier material to produce a single dosage form will generally be that amount of the compound which produces a therapeutic effect. Generally, this amount will range from about 1 % to about 99% of active ingredient, preferably from about 5% to about 70%, most preferably from about 10% to about 30%.
[00243] Wetting agents, emulsifiers and lubricants, such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, release agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the compositions.
[00244] Examples of pharmaceutically-acceptable antioxidants include: water soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfate, sodium metabisulfite, sodium sulfite and the like; oil-soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), lecithin, propyl gallate, alpha-tocopherol, and the like; and metal chelating agents, such as citric acid, ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), sorbitol, tartaric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like.

95 of 205
[00245] Formulations of the present invention include those suitable for oral, nasal, topical (including buccal and sublingual), rectal, vaginal and/or parenteral administration. The formulations may conveniently be presented in unit dosage form and may be prepared by any methods well known in the art of pharmacy. In certain embodiments, a formulation of the present invention comprises an excipient selected from the group consisting of cyclodextrins, liposomes, micelle forming agents, e.g., bile acids, and polymeric carriers, e.g., polyesters and polyanhydrides; and a compound of the present invention. In certain embodiments, an aforementioned formulation renders orally bioavailable a compound of the present invention.
[00246] Methods of preparing these formulations or compositions include the step of bringing into association a compound of the present invention with the carrier and, optionally, one or more accessory ingredients. In general, the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association a compound of the present invention with liquid carriers, or finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
[00247] Formulations of the invention suitable for oral administration may be in the form of capsules, cachets, pills, tablets, lozenges (using a flavored basis, usually sucrose and acacia or tragacanth), powders, granules, or as a solution or a suspension in an aqueous or non-aqueous liquid, or as an oil-in-water or water-in-oil liquid emulsion, or as an elixir or syrup, or as pastilles (using an inert base, such as gelatin and glycerin, or sucrose and acacia) and/or as mouth washes and the like, each containing a predetermined amount of a compound of the present invention as an active ingredient. A compound of the present invention may also be administered as a bolus, electuary or paste.
[00248] In solid dosage forms of the invention for oral administration (capsules, tablets, pills, dragees, powders, granules and the like), the active ingredient is mixed with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers, such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate, and/or any of the following: fillers or extenders, such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and/or silicic acid; binders, such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, sucrose and/or acacia; humectants, such as glycerol;
disintegrating agents, such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates, and sodium carbonate; solution retarding agents, such as paraffin; absorption accelerators, such as quaternary ammonium compounds; wetting agents, such as, for example, cetyl alcohol, glycerol 96 of 205 monostearate, and non-ionic surfactants; absorbents, such as kaolin and bentonite clay;
lubricants, such as talc, calcium stearate, magnesium stearate, solid polyethylene glycols, sodium lauryl sulfate, and mixtures thereof; and coloring agents. In the case of capsules, tablets and pills, the pharmaceutical compositions may also comprise buffering agents. Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-shelled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugars, as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like.
[00249] A tablet may be made by compression or molding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients. Compressed tablets may be prepared using binder (for example, gelatin or hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose), lubricant, inert diluent, preservative, disintegrant (for example, sodium starch glycolate or cross-linked sodium carboxymethyl cellulose), surface-active or dispersing agent. Molded tablets may be made in a suitable machine in which a mixture of the powdered compound is moistened with an inert liquid diluent.
[00250] The tablets, and other solid dosage forms of the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention, such as dragees, capsules, pills and granules, may optionally be scored or prepared with coatings and shells, such as enteric coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical-formulating art. They may also be formulated so as to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein using, for example, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose in varying proportions to provide the desired release profile, other polymer matrices, liposomes and/or microspheres. They may be formulated for rapid release, e.g., freeze-dried.
They may be sterilized by, for example, filtration through a bacteria-retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions that can be dissolved in sterile water, or some other sterile injectable medium immediately before use.
These compositions may also optionally contain opacifying agents and may be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain portion of the gastrointestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner. Examples of embedding compositions that can be used include polymeric substances and waxes. The active ingredient can also be in micro-encapsulated form, if appropriate, with one or more of the above-described excipients.
[00251] Liquid dosage forms for oral administration of the compounds of the invention include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups 97 of 205 and elixirs. In addition to the active ingredient, the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as, for example, water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers, such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof.
[00252] Besides inert diluents, the oral compositions can also include adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring, coloring, perfuming and preservative agents.
[00253] Suspensions, in addition to the active compounds, may contain suspending agents as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar and tragacanth, and mixtures thereof.
[00254] Formulations of the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention for rectal or vaginal administration may be presented as a suppository, which may be prepared by mixing one or more compounds of the invention with one or more suitable nonirritating excipients or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
[00255] Formulations of the present invention which are suitable for vaginal administration also include pessaries, tampons, creams, gels, pastes, foams or spray formulations containing such carriers as are known in the art to be appropriate.
[00256] Dosage forms for the topical or transdermal administration of a compound of this invention include powders, sprays, ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, solutions, patches and inhalants. The active compound may be mixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically-acceptable carrier, and with any preservatives, buffers, or propellants which may be required.
[00257] The ointments, pastes, creams and gels may contain, in addition to an active compound of this invention, excipients, such as animal and vegetable fats, oils, waxes, paraffins, 98 of 205 starch, tragacanth, cellulose derivatives, polyethylene glycols, silicones, bentonites, silicic acid, talc and zinc oxide, or mixtures thereof.
[00258] Powders and sprays can contain, in addition to a compound of this invention, excipients such as lactose, talc, silicic acid, aluminum hydroxide, calcium silicates and polyamide powder, or mixtures of these substances. Sprays can additionally contain customary propellants, such as chlorofluorohydrocarbons and volatile unsubstituted hydrocarbons, such as butane and propane.
[00259] Transdermal patches have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of a compound of the present invention to the body. Dissolving or dispersing the compound in the proper medium can make such dosage forms. Absorption enhancers can also be used to increase the flux of the compound across the skin. Either providing a rate controlling membrane or dispersing the compound in a polymer matrix or gel can control the rate of such flux.
[00260] Ophthalmic formulations, eye ointments, powders, solutions and the like, are also contemplated as being within the scope of this invention.
[00261] Pharmaceutical compositions of this invention suitable for parenteral administration comprise one or more compounds of the invention in combination with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable sterile isotonic aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions, or sterile powders which may be reconstituted into sterile injectable solutions or dispersions just prior to use, which may contain sugars, alcohols, antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostats, solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient or suspending or thickening agents.
[00262] Examples of suitable aqueous and nonaqueous carriers, which may be employed in the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as ethyl oleate. Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants.
[00263] These compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of microorganisms upon the subject compounds may be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and 99 of 205 antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and the like. It may also be desirable to include isotonic agents, such as sugars, sodium chloride, and the like into the compositions. In addition, prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form may be brought about by the inclusion of agents which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
[00264] In some cases, in order to prolong the effect of a drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material having poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution, which in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally-administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
[00265] Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsule matrices of the subject compounds in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide.
Depending on the ratio of drug to polymer, and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of drug release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions, which are compatible with body tissue.
[00266] In certain embodiments, a compound or pharmaceutical preparation is administered orally. In other embodiments, the compound or pharmaceutical preparation is administered intravenously. Alternative routs of administration include sublingual, intramuscular, and transdermal administrations.
[00267] When the compounds of the present invention are administered as pharmaceuticals, to humans and animals, they can be given per se or as a pharmaceutical composition containing, for example, 0.1% to 99.5% (more preferably, 0.5% to 90%) of active ingredient in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
[00268] The preparations of the present invention may be given orally, parenterally, topically, or rectally. They are of course given in forms suitable for each administration route.
For example, they are administered in tablets or capsule form, by injection, inhalation, eye 100 of 205 lotion, ointment, suppository, etc. administration by injection, infusion or inhalation; topical by lotion or ointment; and rectal by suppositories. Oral administrations are preferred.
[00269] These compounds may be administered to humans and other animals for therapy by any suitable route of administration, including orally, nasally, as by, for example, a spray, rectally, intravaginally, parenterally, intracisternally and topically, as by powders, ointments or drops, including buccally and sublingually.
[00270] Regardless of the route of administration selected, the compounds of the present invention, which may be used in a suitable hydrated form, and/or the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention, are formulated into pharmaceutically-acceptable dosage forms by conventional methods known to those of skill in the art.
[00271] Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions of this invention may be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient that is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular patient, composition, and mode of administration, without being toxic to the patient.
[00272] The selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the particular compound of the present invention employed, or the ester, salt or amide thereof, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of excretion or metabolism of the particular compound being employed, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials used in combination with the particular compound employed, the age, sex, weight, condition, general health and prior medical history of the patient being treated, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
[00273] A physician or veterinarian having ordinary skill in the art can readily determine and prescribe the effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition required.
For example, the physician or veterinarian could start doses of the compounds of the invention employed in the pharmaceutical composition at levels lower than that required to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and then gradually increasing the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
[00274] In some embodiments, a compound or pharmaceutical composition of the invention is provided to a subject chronically. Chronic treatments include any form of repeated administration for an extended period of time, such as repeated administrations for one or more months, between a month and a year, one or more years, or longer. In many embodiments, a 101 of 205 chronic treatment involves administering a compound or pharmaceutical composition of the invention repeatedly over the life of the subject. Preferred chronic treatments involve regular administrations, for example one or more times a day, one or more times a week, or one or more times a month. In general, a suitable dose such as a daily dose of a compound of the invention will be that amount of the compound that is the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect. Such an effective dose will generally depend upon the factors described above.
Generally doses of the compounds of this invention for a patient, when used for the indicated effects, will range from about 0.000 1 to about 100 mg per kg of body weight per day. Preferably the daily dosage will range from 0.001 to 50 mg of compound per kg of body weight, and even more preferably from 0.01 to 10 mg of compound per kg of body weight. However, lower or higher doses can be used. In some embodiments, the dose administered to a subject may be modified as the physiology of the subject changes due to age, disease progression, weight, or other factors.
[00275] In some embodiments, provided adjuvant compounds are administered as pharmaceutical compositions or vaccines. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 1-2000 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 1-1000 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 1-500 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 1-250 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 100-1000 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 100-500 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 100-200 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 250-500 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 10-1000 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 500-1000 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 50-250 g. In certain embodiments, the amount of adjuvant compound administered is 50-500 g.
[00276] If desired, the effective daily dose of the active compound may be administered as two, three, four, five, six or more sub-doses administered separately at appropriate intervals throughout the day, optionally, in unit dosage forms.

102 of 205
[00277] While it is possible for a compound of the present invention to be administered alone, in certain embodiments the compound is administered as a pharmaceutical formulation (composition) as described above.
[00278] The compounds according to the invention may be formulated for administration in any convenient way for use in human or veterinary medicine, by analogy with other pharmaceuticals.
[00279] The invention provides kits comprising pharmaceutical compositions of an inventive compound. In certain embodiments, such kits including the combination of a compound of formulae I, II, III, or IV and an antigen. The agents may be packaged separately or together. The kit optionally includes instructions for prescribing the medication. In certain embodiments, the kit includes multiple doses of each agent. The kit may include sufficient quantities of each component to treat a subject for a week, two weeks, three weeks, four weeks, or multiple months. The kit may include a full cycle of immunotherapy. In some embodiments, the kit includes a vaccine comprising one or more bacterial, viral, protozoal, or tumor-associated antigens, and one or more provided compounds.
[00280] The entire contents of all references cited above and herein are hereby incorporated by reference.
[00281] The foregoing written specification is considered to be sufficient to enable one skilled in the art to practice the invention. The present invention is not to be limited in scope by examples provided, since the examples are intended as a single illustration of one aspect of the invention and other functionally equivalent embodiments are within the scope of the invention.
Various modifications of the invention in addition to those shown and described herein will become apparent to those skilled in the art from the foregoing description and fall within the scope of the appended claims. The advantages and objects of the invention are not necessarily encompassed by each embodiment of the invention.

103 of 205 EXAMPLES
Example 1
[00282] The synthesis of the hexasaccharide fragment within QS-7-Api (Figure 1) required initial preparation of the selectively protected monosaccharides 2-4, 6, and 8 (Scheme 7). While the xylo-, gluco- and apio-derived monosaccharides 2-4 (Scheme 7A) were obtained in multi-step sequences by previously reported procedures and modifications thereof (Kim, Y. J.;
Wang, P.; Navarro-Villalobos, M.; Rohde, B. D.; Derryberry, J.; Gin, D. Y. J.
Am. Chem. Soc.
2006,128,11906-11915; Nguyen, H. M.; Chen, Y. N.; Duron, S. G.; Gin, D. Y. J.
Am. Chem.
Soc. 2001, 123, 8766-8772) the novel sugars 6 and 8 were prepared from rhamnopyranose 5 and fucopyranoside 7, respectively. Silylation of the selectively-protected rhamnopyranose 5 (Scheme 7B) with TIPSOTf provided the a-TIPS glycoside (96%), which subsequently underwent C4-O-debenzylation to furnish the rhamnopyranoside 6 (98%).
Synthesis of the fucosyl residue within QS-7 commenced with selective C3-O-alkylation of the allyl fucopyranoside 7 (Scheme 7C) with PMBC1(56%) via its transient stannylene acetal. This allowed for sequential selective silylation of the equatorial C2-OH (97%) and acetylation of the axial C4-OH (>99%). Finally, oxidative removal of the PMB ether with DDQ
provided the selectively-protected fucopyranoside 8 (86%).

Scheme 7' (A) HOB, CI3C OT/OBn AcO OAc BnO O -OBn OH HN OBzO~O O
Bn AcO
2 n OBn ---------------------------------- -------------------------------(8) OR 5 R' = H (C) OAllyl 7 R2 = H
R2Oe `O a bI R?=Bn c-f R H
O R O 0 Me 1 Me 6 R' = TIPS HOOR2 8 R2 = TBS
Me R2=H R =Ac 'Reagents and conditions: (a) TIPSOTf, 2,6-lutidine, CH2C12, 0-*23 C, 96%;
(b) H2, Pd-C, MeOH, 23 C, 98%; (c) n-Bu2SnO, PhMe, reflux; CsF; PMBC1, DMF, 23 C, 56%; (d) TBSC1, imidazole, DMAP, CH2C12, 23 C, 97%; (e) Ac20, Et3N, DMAP, CH2C12, 23 C, >99%; (f) DDQ, MeOH, H2O, 0-*23 C, 86%.

104 of 205
[00283] Convergent assembly of the branched hexasaccharide (Scheme 8) involved dehydrative glycosylation (Ph2SO=Tf2O) (Garcia, B. A.; Gin, D. Y. J. Am. Chem.
Soc. 2000,122, 4269-4279) of fucopyranoside 8 with rhamnopyranose 5 (84%). The resulting (X-disaccharide 9 then underwent a series of protective group exchanges, including TBS removal (95%), a novel Et2Zn/Pd(PPh3)4-mediated anomeric de-allylation (68%), (Chandrasekhar, S.;
Reddy, C. R.; Rao, R. J. Tetrahedron 2001, 57, 3435-3438) and selective anomeric silylation (75%) to afford the disaccharide 10 as a suitable glycosyl acceptor. Its glycosyl donor coupling partner was prepared by chemo- and stereoselective dehydrative glycosylation of rhamnopyranoside 6 with xylopyranose 2 to afford the 0-disaccharide 11 (75%), which directly underwent modified Helferich glycosylation (Roush, W. R.; Bennett, C. E. J. Am. Chem. Soc.
1999,121, 3541-3542) with the apiose-derived donor 4 to afford trisaccharide 12 (86%). The acetate esters in 12 were then exchanged for a benzylidene acetal protective group (94%), followed by selective acid hydrolysis of the rhamno-derived isopropylidene ketal to afford the corresponding vicinal diol (71 %). Selective alkylation of the resulting axial rhamno-C2-OH with BnBr could then be accomplished (84%), allowing for Schmidt glycosylation (Schmidt, R. R.; Kinzy, W. Adv.
Carbohydr. Chem. Biochem. 1994, 50, 21-123) of the C3-OH with the glucosyl imidate 3 to afford the tetrasaccharide 13 (86%). Exchange of the benzoate ester for a TES
ether (91%, 2 steps) and conversion of the anomeric TIPS group to its a-trichloroacetimidate counterpart 14 (92%, 2 steps) secured a suitable donor for glycosylation of disaccharide 10.
This was accomplished by treating the two components with TMSOTf to afford hexasaccharide 15 (62%), whose fucosyl-TIPS-acetal was then transformed to the a-trichloroacetimidate 16 (84%, 2 steps).

105 of 205 Scheme 8' 5+8 6+2 V a Bno OAIIyI OH
TBSO O Me MA Me OOAc p 1__OOBn Me 0 11 Bno O O OTIPS

9 Mee f BnoAc'0~,-~~oAc r ~ L
b-d < O OBn Me TIPSO Ne O
O ` Me 0--Me H oIAc p p OBn 12 Op Me- / O "
BnO--- OTIPS H Ph Y 9 k$ Bno p _ Me me !!!''' t O OBn O
H Ph ~
O~O BnO Me OBn Bno p.. o -O OBn O L-OBn X R /OBn O OBn BnO Me . 1 ~ 13 X = OTIPS
O 1 p OBn OBn I y R=Bz O O 14 X = OC(NH)CC13 X Et3SiO- - R = SiEt3 O Me OBn pOAc Me''O / 15 X = (i-OTIPS
r~
Bno o Q' ' 16 X = a-OC(NH)CC13 O
Me 'Reagents and conditions: (a) Ph2S0, Tf20, TBP, CH2C12, -78-*23 C, 84%; (b) TBAF, THF, 0-*23 C, 95%; (c) Et2Zn, Pd(PPh3)4, Et20, 23 C; 68%; (d) TIPSCI, imidazole, DMAP, DMF, 23 C, 75%; (e) Ph2S0, Tf20, TBP, CH2C12, -78-*23 C, 75%; (f) 4, TBSOTf, CH2C12, 0 C, 86%; (g) K2C03, H20, MeOH, 23 C; (h) PhCH(OMe)2,p-TsOH, 23 C, 94% (2 steps);
(i) p-TsOH, H2O, MeOH, 23 C, 71%; (j) BnBr, Bu4NBr, NaOH, H2O, CH2C12, 23 C, 84%;
(k) 3, TMSOTf, Et20, -45 C, 86%; (1) DIBAL-H, CH2C12, -78 C, 92%; (m) TESOTf, 2,6-lutidine, CH2C12, 0-*23 C, 99%; (n) TBAF, THF, 0 C, >99%; (o) CC13CN, DBU, CH2C12, 0 C, 92%;
(p) TMSOTf, 4A ms, CH2C12, -15 C, 62%; (q) TBAF, THF, 0 C; (r) CC13CN, DBU, CH2C12, 0-*23 C, 84% (2 steps).
[00284] Late stage construction of the full QS-7-Api skeleton involved the elaborately-protected triterpene-trisaccharide conjugate 18 (Scheme 9A), previously prepared from 106 of 205 glucuronolactone 17 during the course of the synthesis of QS-21 (Kim, et al., supra). This C28-carboxylic acid glycosyl acceptor 18 responded well to glycosylation with trichloroacetimidate glycosyl donor 16 (BF3.OEt2) to afford fully protected QS-7-Api (71%), which underwent global deprotection under carefully managed conditions (TFA; H2, Pd-C). The resulting product (71 %) was found to be identical to naturally derived QS-7-Api (1) (trace quantities of natural QS-7-Api (-70% purity, NMR) were obtained from exhaustive RP-HPLC purification of commercial Quil-A ($90/g).
[00285] This synthesis of 1 (Scheme 9A) from de novo construction of all oligosaccharide fragments confirms the structure of QS-7-Api and provides significantly more dependable access to homogeneous samples of 1 than isolation from natural sources. This notwithstanding, the synthesis of 1 can be further augmented. Quil-A (19, Scheme 9B) is a commercially available semi-purified extract from Quillaja saponaria and contains variable quantities of >50 distinct saponins (Vansetten, supra), many of which incorporate the triterpene-trisaccharide substructure within QS-7 (and QS-21). This monodesmoside saponin 20 (Scheme 9B) can be isolated in semi-pure form via direct base hydrolysis of the Quil-A mixture (Higuchi et al., supra). Subsequent poly(silylation) of 20 with excess TESOTf afforded the corresponding nonakis(triethylsilyl ether) (257 mg from 1.15 g of 19), whose glucuronic acid functionality could be selectively derivatized to the benzyl ester 21 (CbzCl, 68%). This triterpene-trisaccharide conjugate, obtained in only a 3-step protocol from Quil-A (19), was an effective donor in a C28-carboxylate glycosylation (80%) with hexasaccharide 16 to provide, after global deprotection, QS-7-Api (1) (77%). The evolution of the first synthesis of 1 to this semi-synthetic variant furnishes complex QS-saponin adjuvants (and likely non-natural analogues) with markedly enhanced facility, enabling heretofore untapped opportunities for novel adjuvant discovery in antitumor and antiviral vaccine development.

107 of 205 Scheme 9' (18 steps; Ref. 13] 18 a, b R1, R3 = Bn -- QS-7-Api (1) HO H R2 = SiEt3 (A) O OH
O O OH
;. Me Me H za R 3 02C Me O 0 HCHOH H Me RzpMeMe R O OR' OR1 R1O ORz (B) Quil-A (19) ~

f, g C 20 d, e R R 2 R3 - H R1, R 2 = SiEt3 - QS-7-Api (1) -R3=Bn 'Reagents and conditions: (a) 16, BF3.OEt2, 4A ms, CH2C12, -78-*23 C, 71%;
(b) TFA, H20, CH2C12, 0 C; H2, Pd-C, EtOH, THF, 23 C, 71%; (c) KOH, EtOH, H20, 80 C; (d) TESOTf, Py, 40 C; (e) CbzCl, Py, TBP, CH2C12, 23 C, 68%; (f) 16, BF3.OEt2, 4A ms, CH2C12, -78-*23 C, 80%; (g) H2, Pd-C, EtOH, THF, 23 C; TFA, H20, 0 C, 77%.

Experimental Procedures General Procedures.
[00286] Reactions were performed in flame-dried sealed-tubes or modified Schlenk (Kjeldahl shape) flasks fitted with a glass stopper under a positive pressure of argon, unless otherwise noted. Air- and moisture-sensitive liquids and solutions were transferred via syringe.
The appropriate carbohydrate and sulfoxide reagents were dried via azeotropic removal of water with toluene. Molecular sieves were activated at 350 C and were crushed immediately prior to use, then flame-dried under vacuum. Organic solutions were concentrated by rotary evaporation below 30 C. Flash column chromatography was performed employing 230-400 mesh silica gel.
Thin-layer chromatography was performed using glass plates pre-coated to a depth of 0.25 mm with 230-400 mesh silica gel impregnated with a fluorescent indicator (254 nm).

108 of 205 Materials.
[00287] Lyophilized QS saponin Quil-A (batch L77-244) was obtained from Brenntag Biosector (Frederikssund, Denmark) via distribution by Accurate Chemical and Scientific Corporation (Westbury, NY). Dichloromethane, tetrahydrofuran, diethyl ether, hexane, toluene, and benzene were purified by passage through two packed columns of neutral alumina under an argon atmosphere. Methanol was distilled from magnesium at 760 Torr.
Trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride was distilled from phosphorus pentoxide at 760 Torr.
Boron trifluoride diethyl etherate and pyridine were distilled from calcium hydride at 760 Torr.
Dimethylformamide was dried over 4A molecular sieves. All other chemicals were obtained from commercial vendors and were used without further purification unless noted otherwise.
Instrumentation.
[00288] Infrared (IR) spectra were obtained using a Perkin Elmer Spectrum BX
spectrophotometer or a Bruker Tensor 27. Data are presented as the frequency of absorption (cm 1). Proton and carbon-13 nuclear magnetic resonance ('H NMR and 13C NMR) spectra were recorded on a Varian 400, a Varian 500, a Varian Inova 500, or a Bruker Avarice III instrument;
chemical shifts are expressed in parts per million (6 scale) downfield from tetramethylsilane and are referenced to the residual protium in the NMR solvent (CHC13: 6 7.26 for iH NMR, 6 77.16 for 13C NMR). Data are presented as follows: chemical shift, multiplicity (s =
singlet, bs = broad singlet, d = doublet, bd = broad doublet, t = triplet, q = quartet, in =
multiplet and/or multiple resonances), coupling constant in Hertz (Hz), integration, assignment. RP-HPLC
purification and analyses were carried out on a Waters 2545 binary gradient HPLC system equipped with a Waters 2996 photodiode array detector, and absorbances were monitored at a wavelength of 214 nm.

PREPARATION OF THE HEXASACCHARIDE

OH OTIPS
Me O Me O
BnO Bn0 O o OYO
V
Me Me Me Me SI

109 of 205
[00289] O-Triisopropyl4-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (Si). To a solution of rhamnopyranoside 5 (Nguyen, H. M.; Poole, J. L.; Gin, D. Y. Angew.
Chem. Int. Ed. 2001, 40, 414-417) (6.00 g, 20.4 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in dichloromethane (100 mL) at 0 C was added 2,6-lutidine (8.30 mL, 71.4 mmol, 3.50 equiv) and triisopropylsilyl trifluoromethanesulfonate (9.30 mL, 34.7 mmol, 1.70 equiv). The reaction was stirred at this temperature for 1 h and then at 23 C for 3 h. Saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (150 mL) was added, and the aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (3 x 150 mL). The combined organic phase was washed with saturated aqueous NaC1(150 mL), dried (Na2S04), filtered and concentrated. Silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 20:1) afforded a-anomer Si (8.8 g, 20 mmol, 96% yield) as a colorless liquid. 'H NMR (CDC13, 500 MHz) 6 7.39-7.33 (m, 4H, aromatic), 7.30-7.26 (m, 1H, aromatic), 5.38 (s, 1H, H-1), 4.93 (d, J= 10.2 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.65 (d, J= 10.2 Hz, 1H, PhCHh-), 4.32 (dd, J= 7.0, 5.6 Hz, 1H, H-3), 4.13 (d, J= 5.6 Hz, 1H, H-2), 3.95 (qd, J= 9.9, 6.2 Hz, 1H, H-5), 3.25 (dd, J= 9.9, 7.0 Hz, 1H, H-4), 1.53 (s, 3H, Me), 1.40 (s, 3H, Me), 1.29 (d, J= 6.3 Hz, 3H, Me), 1.18-1.08 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3);
'3C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 138.51, 128.41, 128.17, 127.76, 109.31, 91.80, 81.56, 78.80, 78.15, 73.25, 64.54, 28.23, 26.66, 17.89, 17.81, 12.04; FTIR (neat film) 3032, 2941, 2896, 2868, 1463, 1382, 1370, 1243, 1220, 1081, 1058, 1020, 995, 883 cm1 .

OTIPS OTIPS
MO Me O
Bn0e -- HO

Me Me me 6 [0001] O-Triisopropyl 2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (6). To a solution of Si (5.90 g, 13.1 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in methanol (100 mL) was added 10% (dry basis) palladium on carbon, wet, Degussa type E101 NE/W (1.4 g, 0.65 mmol, 0.050 equiv). The reaction mixture was vigorously stirred under hydrogen pressure (110 psi) for 7.5 h and was then filtered through a Celite 545 plug, which was rinsed with dichloromethane. The filtrate and rinsings were concentrated, and the residue was subjected to silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 3:1) to afford 6 (4.6 g, 1.3 mmol, 98% yield) as a colorless oil. 'H NMR
(CDC13, 500 MHz) 6 5.34 (s, 1H, H-1), 4.16-4.10 (m, 2H, H-2 and H-3), 3.91 (qd, J= 8.8, 6.3 110 of 205 Hz, 1H, H-5), 3.42 (ddd,J= 11.6, 6.8, 4.8 Hz, 1H, H-4), 2.33 (d, J= 4.8 Hz, 1H, -OH), 1.53 (s, 3H, Me), 1.37 (s, 3H, Me), 1.28 (d, J= 6.3 Hz, 3H, Me), 1.18-1.05 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); 13C NMR
(125 MHz, CDC13) 6 109.5, 91.9, 78.2, 77.6, 74.4, 66.0, 28.0, 26.2, 17.8, 17.68, 17.66, 11.9;
FTIR (neat film) 3463 (br), 2942, 2868, 1464, 1383, 1244, 1220, 1051, 1015, 883, 852, 807 cm'.

OAIIyI OAIIyI
HO y Me - HOy_y Me H`O IOH PMB`O IOH
[00290] Allyl 3-O-methoxybenzyl-a-D-fucopyranoside (S2). Allyl fucoside 7 (111 mg, 0.543 mmol, 1.00 equiv) and dibutyltin oxide (125 mg, 0.502 mmol equiv) in toluene (10 mL) were refluxed for 5 h in a Dean-Stark apparatus. After the reaction mixture cooled to 23 C, CsF
(152 mg, 1.0 mmol) was added, and the solvent was evaporated.
Dimethylformamide (3.0 mL) andp-methoxybenzyl chloride (0.136 mL, 1.0 mmol, 2.0 equiv) were added, and the reaction mixture was stirred at 23 C for 48 h. The solvent was evaporated, and residue taken up in dichloromethane and filtered. The filtrate and rinsings were concentrated, and silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 1:1) afforded S2 (98 mg, 0.30 mmol, 56%) as a colorless oil. 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.32-7.29 (m, 2H), 6.90-6.88 (m, 2H), 5.92 (m, 1H), 5.30 (dq, J= 17.2, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 5.21 (dq, J= 10.4, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 4.93 (d, J= 4.0 Hz, 1H), 4.68 (d, J= 11.6 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-),4.64 (d, J= 11.6 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-),4.20 (ddt, J= 12.8, 5.4, 1.4 Hz, 1H), 4.05 (ddt, J= 12.8, 6.2, 1.3 Hz, 1H), 4.00-3.89 (m, 2H), 3.81 (s, 3H, OMe), 3.80 (m, 1H), 3.64 (dd, J
= 9.7, 3.2 Hz, 1H), 2.40 (s, 1H), 2.11 (d, J= 8.4 Hz, 1H), 1.30 (d, J= 6.6 Hz, 3H); 13C NMR
(125 MHz, CDC13) 6 159.5, 133.8, 130.0, 129.5, 117.7, 114.0, 97.7, 78.5, 71.8, 69.5, 68.5, 68.3, 65.7, 55.3, 16.2. FTIR (neat film) 3462 (br), 3077, 2979, 2907, 2838, 1612, 1514, 1249, 1088, 1037, 821 cm i.

OAI IyI OAIIyI
HOMe - TBSOI y Me PMB``O IIOH PMBOOH

111 of 205
[00291] O-Allyl2-O-t-butyldimethylsilyl-3-O-methoxybenzyl-a-D-fucopyranoside (S3). Fucopyranoside S2 (205 mg, 0.632 mmol, 1.00 equiv), t-butyldimethylsilyl chloride (190 mg, 1.26 mmol, 1.99 equiv), imidazole (129 mg, 1.89 mmol, 3.00 equiv) and 4-(dimethylamino)-pyridine (6.2 mg, 0.051 mmol, 0.080 equiv) were dissolved in dichloromethane (8.0 mL) and stirred at 23 C for 27 h. The reaction mixture was directly purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 7:3) to afford S3 (270 mg, 0.62 mmol, 97% yield). iH NMR
(400 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.32-7.26 (m, 2H), 6.92-6.85 (m, 2H), 5.94 (m, 1H), 5.34 (dq, J=
17.4, 1.4 Hz, 1H), 5.22 (dq, J= 10.3, 1.3 Hz, 1H), 4.79 (d, J= 3.8 Hz, 1H), 4.69 (d, J= 11.3 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.56 (d, J = 11.3 Hz, 1 H, PhCH2-), 4.19 (ddt, J = 13.0, 5.4, 1.3 Hz, 1 H), 4.05 (ddt, J = 13.2, 6.5, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 3.99 (m, 1H), 3.95 (q, J= 6.5 Hz, 1H), 3.82 (s, 3H, OMe), 3.76-3.70 (m, 2H), 2.50 (s, 1H), 1.28 (d, J= 6.6 Hz, 3H), 0.93 (s, 9H), 0.10 (s, 3H), 0.09 (s, 3H); 13C
NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 159.31, 134.16, 130.43, 129.42, 117.73, 113.83, 98.34, 78.27, 72.28, 70.11, 69.29, 68.48, 65.31, 55.21, 25.86, 18.19, 16.17, -4.43, -4.69; FTIR (neat film) 3507 (br), 2953, 2930, 2899, 2857, 1613, 1514, 1250, 1106, 1040, 875, 837, 778 cm i.

IOAAIIIyII OAIIyI
Me TBSOy Me -. TBSO

PMB`O IOH PMB`O IOAC
[00292] O-Allyl4-O-acetyl-2-O-t-butyldimethylsilyl-3-O-methoxybenzyl-a-D-fucopyranoside (S4). To fucopyranoside S3 (264 mg, 0.602 mmol, 1.00 equiv) and (dimethylamino)-pyridine (7.3 mg, 0.060 mmol, 0.10 equiv) in dichloromethane (10 mL) was added triethylamine (0.25 mL, 1.8 mmol, 3.0 equiv) and acetic anhydride (0.17 mL, 0.80 mmol, 3.0 equiv). The reaction mixture was stirred at 23 C for 22.5 h and then was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 17:3) to afford S4 (288 mg, 0.599 mmol, >99% yield) as a colorless oil. 'H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.24-7.21 (m, 2H), 6.85-6.82 (m, 2H), 5.92 (m, 1H), 5.36 (dd, J= 3.2, 1.0 Hz, 1H), 5.32 (dq, J= 17.2, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 5.21 (dq, J= 10.4, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 4.81 (d, J= 3.8 Hz, 1H), 4.60 (d, J= 10.6 Hz, 1H, PhCHH2-), 4.40 (d, J
= 10.6 Hz, 1H, PhCHh-), 4.18 (ddt, J= 13.1, 5.2, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 4.12-4.02 (m, 2H), 3.97 (dd, J=
9.9, 3.8 Hz, 1H), 3.78 (s, 3H), 3.77 (m, 1H), 2.14 (s, 3H), 1.14 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H), 0.89 (s, 9H), 112 of 205 0.04 (s, 3H), 0.03 (s, 3H); 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 170.84, 159.06, 134.07, 130.50, 129.58, 118.00, 113.56, 98.48, 76.12, 71.61, 71.08, 69.56, 68.74, 64.85, 55.24, 25.91, 20.96, 18.30, 16.25, -4.35, -4.90; FTIR (neat film) 2983, 2954, 2930, 2902, 2857, 1742, 1614, 1515, 1249, 1104, 1055. 1040, 1019, 837, 779, 735 cm'; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C25H40O7Si (M+Na+) 503.2441, found 503.2437.

OAIIyI OAIIyI
TBSOOMe - TBSO Me PMB``O IIOAc HO IIOAc
[00293] O-Allyl 4-O-acetyl-2-O-t-butyldimethylsilyl-a-D-fucopyranoside (8). To fucopyranoside S4 (100 mg, 0.208 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in dichloromethane (4 mL) and H2O (0.4 mL) at 0 C was added 2,3-dichloro-5,6-dicyano-1,4-quinone (71 mg, 0.31 mmol, 1.5 equiv).
After stirring at 0 C for 10 min and at 23 C for 2.5 h, reaction mixture was filtered through Celite 435, concentrated, and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 4:1) to afford 8 (65 mg, 0.18 mmol, 86% yield) as a colorless oil. 'H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 5.90 (m, 1H), 5.32 (dq, J= 17.1, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 5.25 (dd, J= 3.5, 1.1 Hz, 1H), 5.20 (dq, J 10.4, 1.3 Hz, 1 H), 4.81 (d, J = 3.7 Hz, 1 H), 4.18 (ddt, J = 13.1, 5.3, 1.5 Hz, 1 H), 4.09 (qd, J = 6.7, 1.0 Hz, 1H), 4.06 (dt, J= 10.0, 3.2 Hz, 1H), 4.00 (qt, J= 6.3, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 3.89 (dd, J= 10.0, 3.7 Hz, 1H), 2.16 (s, 3H), 2.05 (d, J= 3.0 Hz, 1H), 1.13 (d, J= 6.6 Hz, 3H), 0.90 (s, 9H), 0.11 (s, 3H), 0.10 (s, 3H); '3C NMR (100.6 MHz, CDC13) 6 171.12, 133.87, 117.79, 98.26, 73.27, 70.66, 68.80, 68.77, 65.03, 25.80, 20.86, 18.22, 16.11, -4.51, -4.59; FTIR (neat film) 3503, 2927, 1737, 1372, 1242, 1170, 1136, 1087, 1038, 939, 878, 839, 778 cm'; HRMS (ESI) in/z:
Calcd for Ci7H32O6Si (M+Na+) 383.1866, found 383.1864.

OH OAIIyI
Me O TBSO 0 Me O O~Allnyl Bno TBSO 0 Me OOAc Me O
Me ` Me HOOAc Bn0 O

Me Me 113 of 205
[00294] O-Allyl 4-O-acetyl-[4-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranose-(1=3)]-2-O-t-butyldimethylsilyl-a-D-fucopyranoside (9).
Trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride (0.39 mL, 2.3 mmol, 2.8 equiv) was added to a solution of rhamnopyranose 5 (245 mg, 0.832 mmol, 1.00 equiv), phenyl sulfoxide (982 mg, 4.85 mmol, 5.83 equiv) and 2,4,6-tri-t-butylpyridine (1.21 g, 4.89 mmol, 5.88 equiv) in dichloromethane (25 mL) at -78 C. After the reaction was stirred at -78 C for 30 min and at -45 C for 1.5 h, a solution of fucopyranoside 8 (150 mg, 0.416 mmol, 0.500 equiv) in dichloromethane (5.0 mL) was added via cannula. The reaction mixture was stirred at -45 C for 1 h, at 0 C for 1 h and at 23 C for 14 h. Triethylamine (0.1 mL) was added to the reaction mixture, which was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 17:3) to afford 9 (222 mg, 0.349 mmol, 84% yield) as a colorless oil. 'H NMR (CDC13, 400 MHz) 6 7.38-7.22 (m, 5H), 5.90 (m, 1H), 5.23-5.16 (m, 3H), 4.88 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.70 (d, J= 3.6 Hz, 1H), 4.63 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.21-4.05 (m, 5H), 4.02-3.94 (m, 2H), 3.72 (dd, J
10.0, 6.5 Hz, 1H), 3.15 (dd, J= 9.6, 6.0 Hz, 1H), 2.20 (s, 3H, Me), 1.46 (s, 3H, Me), 1.32 (s, 3H, Me), 1.26 (d, J = 6.0 Hz, 3H), 1.09 (d, J = 6.8 Hz, 3H), 0.90 (s, 9H), 0.09 (s, 3H), 0.08 (s, 3H); 13C NMR (100 MHz, CDC13) 6 170.6, 138.8, 134.1, 128.6, 128.4, 128.3, 128.2, 117.9, 108.9, 99.7, 98.7, 81.0, 78.7, 76.3, 75.1, 73.9, 73.1, 70.2, 68.9, 65.38, 65.35, 28.2, 26.4, 26.0, 21.1, 18.2, 17.8, 16.3, -4.2, -4.6; FTIR (neat film) 3066, 3033, 2985, 2934, 2857, 2905, 1747, 1455, 1382, 1373, 1236, 1138, 1096, 1057, 1012, 937, 864, 777, 736, 698 cm1 ;
HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C33H520i0Si (M+NH4+) 654.3674, found 654.3672.

OAIIyI OAIIyI
TBSOMe HO v \_\ Me OIIOAc OOAc Me O Me O
Bn0 Bno Me Me 9 Me Me S5
[00295] O-Allyl 4-O-acetyl-[4-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranose-(1- 3)]-a-D-fucopyranoside (S5). To a solution of disaccharide 9 (190 mg, 0.298 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (10 mL) at 0 C was added tetrabutylammonium 114 of 205 fluoride solution (1.0 M in tetrahydrofuran, 0.33 mL, 0.33 mmol, 1.1 equiv).
After 15 min, the reaction mixture was warmed to 23 C and was stirred at this temperature for 4 h. Silica gel (1 g) was added, the solvent was removed, and the reaction material was purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 3:2) to afford S5 (148 mg, 0.283 mmol, 95% yield). iH
NMR (CDC13, 500 MHz) 6 7.37-7.24 (m, 5H), 5.91 (m, 1H), 5.30 (m, 1H), 5.28 (s, 1H), 5.23 (m, 1H), 5.17 (dd, J= 3.5, 1.0 Hz, 1H), 4.94 (d, J= 3.5 Hz, 1H), 4.86 (d, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.64 (d, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.24-4.16 (m, 3H), 4.08-4.01 (m, 2H), 3.99-3.88 (m, 2H), 3.72 (m, 1 H), 3.18 (dd, J = 9.5, 6.5 Hz, 1 H), 2.13 (s, 3H), 2.01 (d, J =
10.0 Hz, 1 H), 1.47 (s, 3H), 1.35 (s, 3H), 1.26 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H), 1.11 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H); 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 170.6, 138.7, 133.7, 128.4, 128.2, 127.8, 118.4, 109.2, 99.5, 98.1, 80.9, 76.3, 75.5, 73.3, 73.1, 69.4, 69.0, 65.8, 65.5, 28.2, 26.6, 21.0, 17.9, 16.4; FTIR (neat film) 3470 (br), 3032, 2985, 2936, 1744, 1454, 1381, 1237, 1168, 1092, 933, 863, 816, 737, 698 cm-1 ; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C27H38010 (M+Na+) 545.2363, found 545.2355.

OAIIyI OH
HOMe HOMe OIIOAc OOAc Me O Me O
Bn0 BnO

Me Me Me S6
[00296] 4-O-acetyl-[4-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranose-(1-3)]-D-fucopyranose (S6). To disaccharide S5 (80 mg, 0.15 mmol, 1.0 equiv) and Pd(PPh3)4 (18 mg, 0.015 mmol, 0.10 equiv) in diethyl ether (9.0 mL) was added Et2Zn solution (1.0 M in hexane, 1.53 mL, 1.53 mmol, 10.0 equiv). The reaction mixture was stirred at 23 C for 10 h and then another portion of Pd(PPh3)4 (18 mg, 0.015 mmol, 0.10 equiv) was added.
After 11 h, the reaction was diluted with ethyl acetate, followed by the addition of saturated aqueous NaCl. The aqueous phase was extracted by ethyl acetate (2 x 50mL). The combined organic phase was dried (MgS04), filtered, concentrated, and the residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 1:4) to afford the hemiacetal S6 as a mixture of anomers (50 mg, 0.10 mmol, 68% yield). Characteristic peaks: iH NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.37-7.25 (m, 5H), 4.87 115 of 205 (d, J= 11.3 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.64 (d, J= 11.3 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-),1.47 (s, 3H), 1.36 (s, 3H). The hemiacetal mixture was used immediately in the next silylation reaction.

OH
O Me TIPSO~O Me HO O
OOAc OOAc Me Me O
T
BnO BnO
O O OV O
Y
Me Me S6 Me Me 10
[00297] O-Triisopropylsilyl 4-O-acetyl-[4-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranose-(1-+3)]- (3-D-fucopyranoside (10). To a solution of hemiacetal S6 (57 mg, 0.12 mmol, 1.0 equiv), imidazole (64 mg, 0.94 mmol, 8.0 equiv) and 4-(dimethylamino)-pyridine (3 mg, 0.02 mmol, 0.2 equiv) in dimethylformamide (0.5 mL) was treated with triisopropylsilylchloride (150 L, 0.70 mmol, 5.9 equiv). The reaction was stirred at 23 C for 4 h, then directly purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 4:1) to afford 10 (56 mg, 0.088 mmol, 75%) as a white powder. iH NMR (CDC13, 500 MHz) 6 7.38-7.25 (m, 5H), 5.32 (s, 1H), 5.12 (dd, J= 3.0, 1.3 Hz, 1H), 4.85 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCHh-), 4.64 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.55 (d, J= 7.5 Hz, 1H), 4.18 (m, 2H), 3.82-3.64 (m, 4H), 3.18 (m, 1H), 2.18 (d, J= 2.0 Hz, 1H), 2.12 (s, 3H), 1.48 (s, 3H), 1.36 (s, 3H), 1.26 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H), 1.14 (d, J=
6.5 Hz, 3H), 1.10-1.02 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 170.8, 138.7, 128.4, 128.2, 127.8, 109.2, 99.2, 97.9, 80.9, 78.6, 76.7, 76.4, 74.2, 73.1, 72.7, 70.0, 65.5, 28.2, 26.6, 21.0, 18.05, 18.00, 17.9, 16.5, 12.5; FTIR (neat film) 3496 (br), 3089, 3064, 3032, 2938, 2866, 1744, 1455, 1381, 1237, 1076, 737 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C33H54O9Si (M+Na+) 645.3435, found 645.3421.

116 of 205 BnO
OTIPS OH
Me O HO Meme O
HO YO BnO~OBn O Me_ OBn Me 6 Me 2O 11 OTIPS
[00298] O-Triisopropylsilyl [2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1 =4)]-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (11). To a solution of xylopyranose 2 (140 mg, 0.424 mmol, 1.00 equiv), phenylsulfoxide (500 mg, 2.47 mmol, 5.83 equiv) and 2,4,6-tri-t-butylpyridine (604 mg, 2.44 mmol, 5.78 equiv) in dichloromethane (16 mL) at -78 C was added trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride (0.20 mL, 1.19 mmol, 2.80 equiv). After 15 min, a solution of rhamnopyranoside 6 (305 mg, 0.846 mmol, 2.00 equiv) in dichloromethane (5 mL) was added via cannula. The reaction mixture was stirred at -78 C for 15 min, at -45 C
for 30 min, at 0 C
for 30 min, at 23 C for 10 h, at 35 C for 5 h, and finally at 23 C for another 9 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with dichloromethane (100 mL) and washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (2 x 100 mL) and saturated aqueous NaCl (2 x 100 mL). The aqueous washings were extracted with dichloromethane (150 mL), and the combined organic phase was dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to furnish a cream-colored amorphous solid. Silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 7:3) afforded 11 (215 mg, 75% yield) as a white amorphous solid. 'H NMR (CDC13, 500 MHz) 6 7.40-7.27 (m, 1OH), 5.37 (s, 1H), 4.94 (d, J=
11.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.92 (d, J= 7.2 Hz, 1H), 4.75 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-), 4.66 (d, J-11.5 Hz, 1 H, PhCH2-), 4.64 (d, J = 12.0 Hz, 1 H, PhCHh-), 4.22 (dd, J = 7.0, 5.0 Hz, 1 H), 4.06 (dd, J = 5.0, 0.5 Hz, 1 H), 3.96 (dd, J = 11.5, 5.5 Hz, 1 H), 3.87 (m, 1 H), 3.72 (t, J = 9.0 Hz, 1 H), 3.64 (dd, J = 10.0, 7.5 Hz, 1 H), 3.53 (m, 1 H), 3.24 (d, J = 10.0 Hz, 1 H), 3.21 (t, J = 9.5 Hz, 2 H), 3.18 (d, J= 9.0 Hz, 1H), 1.51 (s, 3H), 1.36 (s, 3H), 1.26 (d, J= 6.0 Hz, 3H), 1.18-1.05 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 170.8, 138.7, 128.4, 128.2, 127.8, 109.2, 99.2, 97.9, 80.9, 78.6, 76.7, 76.4, 74.2, 73.1, 72.7, 70.0, 65.5, 28.2, 26.6, 21.0, 18.05, 18.00, 17.9, 16.5, 12.5; FTIR (neat film) 3483 (br), 3031, 2942, 2867, 1497, 1455, 1383, 1242, 1221, 1085, 1018, 883, 809, 735, 697 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C37H56O9Si (M+Na+) 695.3591, found 695.3594.

117 of 205 BnO BnO AcO O OAc OH O OBn McMe O McMe O
1AcQ OAc OI Me OBn õ pp Me _O OBn IPS p 11 ACO 4 OBn 0 2 I f _ OTIPS
OTIPS
[00299] O-Triisopropylsilyl }[2,3-di-O-acetyl-5-O-benzyl-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(1=3)]-2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1 =4)] }-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (12). To a solution of 1,2,3-tri-O-acetyl-5-O-benzyl-(3-D-apiofuranoside (4) (466 mg, 1.27 mmol, 1.89 equiv) and 11 (452 mg, 0.672 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in dichloromethane (19 mL) at 0 C was added t-butyldimethylsilyl trifluoromethanesulfonate (7.7 L, 0.034 mmol, 0.050 equiv). After 25 min triethylamine (0.1 mL) was added. The reaction mixture was concentrated, and the residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 4:1 to 3:2) to afford 12 (567 mg, 0.579 mmol, 86% yield) as a colorless oil.
Rf = 0.58 (hexanes/ethyl acetate 2:1); 1H NMR (CDC13, 500 MHz) 6 7.37-7.23 (m, 15H), 5.47 (s, 1H), 5.45 (s, 1H). 5.36 (s, 1H), 4.89 (d, J= 1.5 Hz, 1H), 4.86 (d, J= 2.0 Hz, 1H), 4.63 (d, J= 11.0 Hz, 1H), 4.56 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-), 4.50 (d, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-),4.42 (d, J=
12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.39 (d, J = 11.5 Hz, 1 H, PhCH2-), 4.21 (d, J = 10.5 Hz, 1 H, PhCHH2-), 4.18 (dd, J =
7.0, 5.5 Hz, 1 H), 4.10 (d, J = 10.5 Hz, 1 H, PhCH2-), 4.07 (d, J = 10.5 Hz, 1 H), 4.03 (d, J = 5.5 Hz, 1H), 3.90-3.82 (m, 3H), 3.76 (t, J= 9.0 Hz, 1H), 3.62 (dd, J= 10.0, 7.5 Hz, 1H), 3.30 (m, 1H), 3.24 (dd, J= 9.5, 8.0 Hz, 1H), 3.14 (dd, J= 12.0, 10.0 Hz, 1H), 2.04 (s, 3H), 1.97 (s, 3H), 1.49 (s, 3H), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.26 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H), 1.20-1.04 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 170.3, 169.4, 138.7, 138.3, 138.1, 128.7, 128.6, 128.4, 128.2, 128.09, 128.04, 127.99, 109.6, 106.7, 101.8, 91.8, 85.9, 82.1, 78.9, 78.4, 78.3, 78.1, 77.5, 76.91, 76.85, 74.5, 73.6, 73.5, 73.2, 69.7, 64.3, 64.0, 28.1, 26.8, 21.6, 20.8, 18.03, 17.97, 17.94, 12.2; FTIR (neat film) 2943, 2868, 1747, 1455, 1370, 1247, 1084, 883, 809 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C53H74015Si (M+Na+) 1001.4695, found 1001.4730.

118 of 205 H Ph BnO AcO O OAc BnO O p O
OOBn OOBn McMe 0 Meme 0 O Me -O OBn -= 0 Mc O OBn OTIPS OTIPS
[00300] O-Triisopropylsilyl }[5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(1 =3)] -2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1 =4)] }-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (S7). Potassium carbonate (221 mg, 1.60 mmol, 6.99 equiv) was added to a solution of trisaccharide 12 (224 mg, 0.229 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in methanol (10 mL) and water (1 mL). The reaction was stirred at 23 C for 1 h. The reaction was diluted with saturated aqueous NH4C1 solution (100 mL) and extracted with dichloromethane (3 x 100 mL). The combined organic phase were dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated in vacuo.
[00301] The residue was treated with a,a-dimethoxytoluene (25 mL) and p-toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate (22 mg, 0.11 mmol, 0.51 equiv) and stirred at 23 C for 2 h.
The reaction mixture was then diluted with dichloromethane (150 mL), and washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic phase was dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo with heating to remove the excess a,a-dimethoxytoluene. The residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 82:18) to give trisaccharide S7 (211 mg, 0.215 mmol, 94% yield over two steps). iH NMR
(CDC13, 400 MHz) 6 7.53-7.23 (m, 20H), 5.98 (s, 1H), 5.74 (s, 1H), 5.36 (s, 1H), 4.90 (d, J= 7.6 Hz, 1H), 4.84 (d, J= 11.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.69 (d, J= 11.0 Hz, 1H, PhCHh-), 4.60 (d, J= 1.4 Hz, 2H), 4.53 (d, J= 11.6 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.52 (s, 1H), 4.46 (d, J= 11.7 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.19 (dd, J = 5.4, 1.7 Hz, 1 H), 4.04 (dd, J = 5.6, 0.7 Hz, 1 H), 3.90-3.79 (m, 3H), 3.65 (s, 3H), 3.61 (dd, J = 7.3, 2.7 Hz, 1 H), 3.27 (dd, J = 7.8, 1.4 Hz, 1 H), 3.16 (dd, J
= 10.1, 1.4 Hz, 1 H), 1.48 (s, 3H), 1.33 (s, 3H), 1.25 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H), 1.20-1.02 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); 13C NMR (100 MHz, CDC13) 6 138.34, 138.28, 138.20, 137.0, 129.9, 128.9, 128.7, 128.6, 128.54, 128.52, 128.04, 127.96, 127.90, 127.7, 127.4, 109.6, 107.5, 106.6, 101.8, 91.9, 87.3, 81.7, 78.4, 78.3, 78.1, 77.8, 76.8, 74.5, 73.8, 73.5, 73.2, 71.3, 64.3, 64.0, 28.1, 26.'8, 18.04, 18.01, 17.95, 12.2; FTIR (neat film) 3090, 3066, 3033, 2943, 2895, 2867, 1497, 1455, 1383, 1370, 1241, 1221, 119 of 205 1086, 1055, 1019, 993, 883, 856, 808, 752, 735, 697 cm-1; HRMS (ESI) in/z:
Calcd for C56H74013Si(M+Na+) 1005.4796, found 1005.4838.

H Ph H Ph Bn0 O O Bn0 00 0 0 0 OBn MeMe 0 O
0 Me HO Me OBn n _p OBn S7 0 p S8 p OH
OTIPS OTIPS
[00302] O-Triisopropylsilyl {[5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(1-+3)]-2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1i4)]}-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (S8).
To a solution of trisaccharide S7 (133 mg, 0.135 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in a mixture of methanol (2.0 mL) and water (6 drops) was addedp-toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate (13 mg, 0.068 mmol, 0.51 equiv). The reaction was stirred at 23 C for 5 d and was then directly purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 1:4 to 1:1) to afford S8 (90 mg, 0.095 mmol 71 % yield) and starting material S7 (10 mg, 0.010 mmol, 7.5% recovered). 'H NMR (CDC13, 500 MHz) 6 7.52-7.50 (m, 2H), 7.40-7.33 (m, 9H), 7.32-7.24 (m, 9H), 5.99 (s, 1H), 5.70 (s, 1H), 5.12 (s, 1H), 4.83 (d, J= 10.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-),4.78 (d, J= 10.5 Hz, 1H, PhCHh-), 4.61 (d, 1 H, J= 2.0 Hz), 4.63 (d, J= 12.5 Hz, 1H, PhCHh-), 4.59 (d, J= 12.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.56-4.54 (m, 2H), 4.54 (d, J = 11.5 Hz, 1 H, PhCHz-), 4.46 (d, J = 11.5 Hz, 1 H, PhCH2-), 3.99 (s, 2H), 3.90-3.78 (m, 5H), 3.67 (m, 2H), 3.46 (t, J= 9.0 Hz, 1 H), 3.40-3.33 (m, 2H), 3.14 (dd, J= 11.5, 10.5 Hz, 1H), 2.26 (d, J= 3.0 Hz, 1H), 1.27 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H), 1.16-1.04 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); '3 C NMR
(125 MHz, CDC13) 6 138.2, 138.1, 137.0, 136.9, 129.9, 128.95, 128.86, 128.7, 128.62, 128.55, 128.2, 128.1, 128.0, 127.7, 127.4, 107.6, 106.7, 104.7, 93.9, 91.8, 87.3, 83.5, 82.8, 78.6, 76.6, 76.1, 73.8, 73.5, 73.4, 72.9, 71.6, 71.0, 66.1, 64.4, 17.97, 17.89, 17.7, 12.1; FTIR (neat film) 3468 (br), 3066, 3033, 2943, 2867, 1455, 1386, 1093, 1053, 986, 882, 861, 734, 696 cm';
HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C53H70013Si (M+Na+) 965.4483, found 965.4470.

120 of 205 H Ph ;Ph X, Bn0 O-O BnO 0 p OOBn O OBn O O
BnO Me O Me O OBn ~pO OBn F~-OH S8 ~O S9 OTIPS OTIPS
[00303] O-Triisopropylsilyl 2-O-benzyl-} [5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(1 =3)]-2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1 =4)] }-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (S9). To a mixture of trisaccharide S8 (87 mg, 0.092 mmol, 1.0 equiv), dichloromethane (2.0 mL) and 20% aqueous NaOH (1.0 mL) was added n-Bu4NBr (6 mg, 0.02 mmol, 0.2 equiv) and benzyl bromide (0.11 mL, 0.92 mmol, 10 equiv). After 20 h at 23 C, the reaction mixture was concentrated and the resulting residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 78:22) to afford S9 (80 mg, 84% yield). 'H NMR (CDC13, 500 MHz) 6 7.52-7.50 (m, 2 H), 7.40-7.24 (m, 23H), 6.00 (s, 1H), 5.71 (s, 1H), 5.10 (s, 1H), 4.85 (d, J=
11.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.77 (d, J= 11.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.71 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.70 (d, J= 8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.66 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-), 4.63 (d, J= 12.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.60 (d, J= 12.5 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-),4.54 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, I H, PhCHz-),4.53 (s, I H), 4.46 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, I H, PhCH2-), 4.01-3.95 (m, 3H), 3.87-3.78 (m, 3H), 3.66 (s, 2H), 3.63 (dd, J= 3.0, 1.5 Hz, 1H), 3.57 (t, J= 9.0 Hz, 1H), 3.38 (m, 1H), 3.28 (dd, J= 9.5, 8.0 Hz, 1H), 3.16 (t, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H), 2.95 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 1H), 1.28 (d, J= 6.0 Hz, 3H), 1.08-0.97 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); '3C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 138.2,138.1, 138.0,137.2,136.8,129.7,128.8,128.51, 128.45,128.43,128.3,128.06,128.04, 127.85, 127.82, 127.75, 127.5, 127.2, 107.4, 106.5, 104.1, 92.3, 91.6, 87.1, 82.2, 82.1, 79.4, 78.1, 76.5, 75.2, 73.6, 73.24, 73.17, 73.0, 71.6, 71.0, 66.4, 64.0, 17.76, 17.74, 17.69, 11.9; FTIR (neat film) 3477 (br), 3068, 3033, 2943, 1465 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C60H76013Si (M+Na+) 1055.4953, found 1055.5006.

121 of 205 H Ph Bn0 O H Ph O OBn Bn0 O
O
O OBn BOO Mee OBn S9 O
OH n Me O OBn OTIPS C13C /.O O OBn OBn HN B00OBBnn OTIPSBBz OBn 3 OBn 13
[00304] O-Triisopropylsilyl [2-O-benzoyl-3,4,6-tri-O-benzyl-(3-D-glucopyranosyl-(1 =3)]-2-O-benzyl-{ [5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-p-D-apiofuranosyl-(1 =3)] -2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1-'4)]}-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (13). To a solution of trisaccharide S9 (88 mg, 0.085 mmol, 1.0 equiv) and glucosyl imidate 3 (131 mg, 0.187 mmol, 2.20 equiv) in diethyl ether (5.0 mL) at -45 C was added a solution of trimethylsilyl trifluoromethanesulphonate (2.3 L, 0.013 mmol, 0.15 equiv) in dichloromethane (115 L).
After 30 min at this temperature, triethylamine (0.15 mL) was added to the reaction mixture, which was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene/ethyl acetate 19:1) to afford 13 (115 mg, 0.0733 mmol, 86% yield). 'H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 8.18 (d, J= 7.5 Hz, 2H), 7.64-7.14 (m, 43H), 6.06 (s, 1H), 5.91 (s, 1H), 5.34 (dd, J= 9.5, 8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.98-4.92 (m, 3H), 4.86-4.81 (m, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 4.77 (d, J= 11.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.75 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-), 4.70-4.58 (m, 6H), 4.47 (d, J= 8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.42 (d, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.37 (d, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.32 (d, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H), 4.20 (dd, J=
9.0, 3.0 Hz, 1H), 4.15 (d, J= 10.5 Hz, I H, PhCHh-), 4.13 (d, J= 10.5 Hz, I H, PhCHz-), 3.88-3.70 (m, 7H), 3.66 (dd, J= 11.5, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 3.59-3.53 (m, 2H), 3.44 (d, J= 10.0 Hz, 1H), 3.29-3.23 (m, 1H), 3.20 (dd, J= 9.0, 8.0 Hz, 1H), 2.32 (m, 1H), 2.05 (t, J= 11.0 Hz, 1H), 1.28 (d, J=
6.0 Hz, 3H), 1.10-0.90 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 165.4, 139.2, 139.1, 138.71, 138.66, 138.64, 138.2, 138.1, 136.9, 133.5, 130.2, 130.1, 129.9, 129.4, 128.94, 128.85, 128.7, 128.60, 128.59, 128.57, 128.55, 128.45, 128.42, 128.1, 128.0, 127.95, 127.93, 127.8, 127.7, 127.6, 127.54, 127.50, 127.4, 107.4, 106.6, 102.7, 100.9, 94.0, 91.9, 87.4, 83.3, 81.8, 79.0, 78.3, 78.0, 77.5, 76.7, 75.3, 74.9, 74.67, 74.64, 74.5, 73.89, 73.87, 73.84, 73.57, 72.8, 71.4, 70.0, 67.3, 63.0, 18.10, 18.04, 18.02, 12.1; FTIR (neat film) 3030, 2938, 2862, 1734, 1452, 1264 cm-1 ; HRMS
(ESI) to/z: Calcd for C94H108019Si (M+Na+) 1569.7332, found 1569.7397.

122 of 205 ;Ph H Ph BnO O0O BnO OOllz~ O

O OBn OOBn O p BO Me OBn BnO Me OB
~% OBn p p n OBn OTIPS B00~\\ OBn 13 HO O O B n S10 OBn OTIPS OBn
[00305] O-Triisopropylsilyl 2-O-benzyl-[3,4,6-tri-O-benzyl-(3-D-glucopyranosyl-(1 =3)]-{ [5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-p-D-apiofuranosyl-(1 =3)] -2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1-+4)]}-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (S10). To a solution of tetrasaccharide 13 (110 mg, 0.0701 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in dichloromethane (15 mL) at -78 C was added diisobutylaluminium hydride solution (1.0 M in hexane, 0.14 mL, 0.14 mmol, 2.0 equiv). After 0.5 h, additional diisobutylaluminium hydride solution (1.0 M in hexane, 0.20 mL, 0.20 mmol, 2.9 equiv) was added, and 0.5 h later, the reaction was quenched with methanol at -78 C. The reaction mixture was concentrated, and the residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 4:1) to afford Sl0 (95 mg, 0.065 mmol, 92% yield). iH
NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.50-7.42 (m, 2H), 7.46-7.14 (m, 38H), 6.02 (s, 1H), 5.86 (s, 1H), 5.06 (d, J= 8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.97-4.92 (m, 2H), 4.88-4.80 (m, 4H), 4.72 (d, J= 11.0 Hz, 1H), 4.68-4.60 (m, 4H), 4.59-4.48 (m, 4H), 4.38 (d, J= 12.0 Hz, 1H), 4.06-3.82 (m, 9H), 3.70 (s, 4H), 3.62 (dd, J= 11.0, 4.0 Hz, 1H), 3.54-3.40 (m, 4H), 3.36-3.26 (m, 2H), 3.22 (d, J= 7.5 Hz, 1H), 2.76 (m, 2H), 1.34 (d, J
= 6.0 Hz, 3H), 1.10-0.90 (m, 21H, Si-i-Pr3); 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 139.3, 139.0, 138.48, 138.45, 138.2, 137.4, 136.8, 129.8, 129.4, 129.1, 128.9, 128.71, 128.66, 128.59, 128.56, 128.48, 128.44, 128.37, 128.05, 127.99, 127.7, 127.59, 127.57, 127.4, 107.8, 106.8, 105.0, 103.1, 93.7, 91.9, 87.5, 85.1, 83.1, 82.8, 79.5, 78.2, 77.4, 77.2, 77.1, 76.1, 75.9, 75.1, 74.7, 74.5, 73.9, 73.7, 73.6, 73.2, 71.3, 69.3, 67.2, 64.2, 18.2, 18.00, 17.97, 12.1; FTIR (neat film) 3436 (br), 3059, 3032, 2930, 2863, 1497, 1455, 1362, 1094, 883 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) to/z:
Calcd for C87H104O18Si (M+NH4+) 1482.7336, found 1482.7333.

123 of 205 H Ph H Ph X, X, Bn0 O Bn0 O
OBn OBn O O
BnO Me OBn BnO Me OBn I/OJ~~/ O OBn O OBn XI~ O OBn S10 OTIPS 3 SD O OBn S11 OTIPS HO
OBn OBn
[00306] O-Triisopropylsilyl 2-O-benzyl-[3,4,6-tri-O-benzyl-2-O-triisopropylsilyl-(3-D-glucopyranosyl-(1 =3)]-{ [5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(1 =3)]-2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1-4)]}-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (S11). To a solution of tetrasaccharide S10 (90 mg, 0.061 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in dichloromethane (10 mL) at 0 C was added 2,6-lutidine (0.21 mL, 1.8 mmol, 26 equiv) and triethylsilyl trifluoromethanesulfonate (0.21 mL, 0.92 mmol, 15 equiv). The reaction mixture was stirred at this temperature for 30 min and at 23 C for 8 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated, and the residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 23:2) to afford S11 (96 mg, 0.061 mmol, 99%
yield). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.50-7.44 (m, 2H), 7.38-7.02 (m, 38H), 5.96 (s, 1H), 5.89 (s, 1H), 5.03 (d, J= 8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.95 (d, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.89-4.82 (m, 3H), 4.80 (d, J= 12.5 Hz, 1H, PhCHh-), 4.75 (d, J= 11.1 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.71 (d, J= 11.2 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.64 (d, J= 7.5 Hz, 1H), 4.63-4.48 (m, 7H), 4.46 (d, J= 11.3 Hz, PhCH2-, 1H), 4.39 (d, J= 12.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.20 (dd, 2 H, 1H, J= 9.0, 3.5 Hz), 4.01 (t, J= 9.5 Hz, 1H), 3.98-3.78 (m, 5H), 3.65-3.54 (m, 4H), 3.50-3.38 (m, 3H), 3.36-3.24 (m, 3H), 3.22 (dd, J= 9.5, 8.0 Hz, 1H), 2.11 (d, J= 9.5 Hz, 1H), 1.31 (d, J= 6.0 Hz, 3H), 1.06-0.89 (m, 29H), 0.72 (m, 6H), 0.56 (m, 1H); '3C
NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 139.4, 139.3, 139.0, 138.8, 138.3, 138.2, 137.0, 129.8, 128.9, 128.7, 128.6, 128.50, 128.45, 128.43, 128.4, 128.3, 128.2, 127.93, 127.90, 127.8, 127.74, 127.70, 127.66, 127.6, 127.5, 127.3, 127.2, 107.5, 106.7, 102.7, 102.1, 93.7, 91.9, 87.4, 85.0, 82.9, 79.3, 78.2, 77.5, 77.35, 77.32, 76.1, 75.7, 75.2, 74.6, 74.5, 74.0, 73.80, 73.78, 73.4, 73.0, 71.3, 69.0, 66.9, 64.1, 18.1, 18.0, 12.1, 7.5, 6.9, 6.1, 5.8; FTIR (neat film) 3065, 3032, 2943, 2871, 1497, 1455, 1364, 1178, 1148, 1094, 1028, 884, 735, 697 cm i; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C93H,18Oi8Si2 (M+Na+) 1601.7754, found 1601.7816.

124 of 205 H Ph H Ph X, X, Bn0 O Bn0 000 O pgn O OBn O O
BnO Me OBn BO Me OBn --" ~O n S11 // . - p pBBn S12 t OSiO \'O~\Bn 333Si0 On OH Et OBn
[00307] 2-O-benzyl-[3,4,6-tri-O-benzyl-2-O-triisopropylsilyl-(3-D-glucopyranosyl-(1 =3)]-{ [5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(I =3)] -2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1-'4)]}-L-rhamnopyranose (S12). To a solution of tetrasaccharide S11 (96 mg, 0.061 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (6 mL) at 0 C was added tetrabutylammonium fluoride solution (1.0 M in tetrahydrofuran, 63 L, 0.063 mmol, 1.0 equiv).
After 3 min, silica gel (120 mg) was added to the reaction mixture, which was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 11:9) to afford hemiacetal S12 (88 mg, quantitative yield). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.49-7.45 (m, 2H), 7.36-7.09 (m, 38H), 5.94 (s, 1H), 5.80 (s, 1H), 5.01 (dd, J= 3.0, 2.8 Hz, 1H), 4.98-4.90 (m, 2H), 4.88-4.76 (m, 3H), 4.76-4.70 (m, 2H), 4.68-4.60 (m, 2H), 4.60-4.53 (m, 2H), 4.53-4.44 (m, 6H), 4.22 (dd, J= 8.5, 3.5 Hz, 1H), 4.00-3.76 (m, 7H), 3.74 (dd, J= 3.0, 2.0 Hz, 1 H), 3.64-3.56 (m, 2H), 3.54-3.20 (m, 9 H), 2.68 (m, 1H), 2.37 (d, J= 3.5 Hz, 1H), 1.32 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H), 0.98 (m, 9H), 0.68-0.52 (m, 6H); 13C
NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 139.3, 138.9, 138.8, 138.7, 138.1, 137.4, 137.0, 128.8, 128.6, 128.54, 128.50, 128.45, 128.43, 128.40, 128.37, 128.3, 128.2, 127.9, 127.8, 127.71, 127.68, 127.64, 127.60, 127.57, 127.54, 127.4, 127.35, 127.30, 127.2, 107.4, 106.6, 102.0, 91.80, 91.78, 87.3, 82.4, 78.7, 78.4, 76.5, 75.9, 75.6, 74.9, 74.8, 74.6, 73.7, 73.5, 73.4, 72.9, 71.3, 69.1, 67.4, 18.2, 18.1, 17.9, 13.1, 12.5, 7.4, 5.7, 5.6; FTIR (neat film) 3401 (br), 3032, 2938, 2874, 1454, 1364, 1095, 1066, 734, 696 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C84H98018Si (M+Na+) 1445.6420, found 1445.6449.

125 of 205 H Ph H Ph Bn0 O O O Bn0 0 0 OOBn 0 OBn BnO Me BnO Me OBn 0 0 OBn B
OBn 0~ S12 p p pBn 14 OH Et3S- 0Bn CI'C O Et3Si0 OBn OBn NH
[00308] O-Trichloroacetimidoyl2-O-benzyl-[3,4,6-tri-O-benzyl-2-O-triisopropylsilyl-(3-D-glucopyranosyl-(1 =3)]-} [5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(1 =3)]-2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1=4)]}-a-L-rhamnopyranoside (14). To a solution of hemiacetal S12 (64 mg, 0.045 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in dichloromethane (10 mL) at 0 C was added trichloroacetonitrile (0.9 mL, 0.9 mmol, 200 equiv) and 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene (62 L, 0.045 mmol, 10 equiv). After 3 h at 0 C, triethylamine (100 L) was added.
The reaction mixture was concentrated, and the residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 7:3) to afford 14 (65 mg, 92% yield). 'H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 8.52 (s, 1H), 7.53-7.49 (m, 2H), 7.41-7.09 (m, 38H), 6.17 (d, J= 2.0 Hz, 1H), 6.00 (s, 1H), 5.90 (s, 1 H), 5.04 (d, J = 7.8 Hz, 1 H), 4.97 (d, J = 11.8 Hz, 1 H, PhCH2-), 4.89 (d, J = 11.8 Hz, 1 H, PhCH2-), 4.85 (d, J = 12.2 Hz, 1 H, PhCH2-), 4.84 (d, J = 11.1 Hz, 1 H, PhCHH2-), 4.78 (d, J = 11.1 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.74 (d, J= 11.3 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.71 (d, J= 11.3 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.65-4.45 (m, 9H), 4.39 (d, J= 12.4 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-), 4.05-3.87 (m, 6H), 3.67 (d, J=
10.5 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-),3.64 (d, J= 10.5 Hz, 1H, PhCHz-),3.57 (t, J= 9.4 Hz, 1H), 3.50-3.40 (m, 3H), 3.40-3.22 (m, 4H), 2.20 (d, J= 9.3 Hz, 1H), 1.41 (d, J= 6.2 Hz, 3H), 1.00-0.92 (m, 9H), 0.80-0.68 (m, 6 H); 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 160.1, 139.1, 138.9, 138.5, 138.35, 138.30, 138.0, 137.9, 136.8, 129.6, 128.7, 128.4, 128.3, 128.24, 128.23, 128.13, 128.09, 128.0, 127.8, 127.75, 127.71, 127.6, 127.50, 127.48, 127.46, 127.34, 127.32, 127.29, 127.2, 127.1, 127.0, 107.3, 106.4, 102.4, 101.7, 96.4, 91.7, 91.4, 87.2, 84.8, 82.6, 78.0, 77.0, 76.9, 76.5, 76.1, 75.6, 75.4, 75.0, 74.31, 74.26, 73.6, 73.49, 73.46, 73.2, 72.8, 71.1, 70.1, 68.5, 18.0, 7.2, 5.5; FTIR
(neat film) 3335, 3063, 3030, 2935, 2876, 1673, 1454, 1363, 1176, 1149, 1095, 1063, 1028, 796, 734, 697 cm i.

126 of 205 H Ph BnO O
H Ph O 11 OBn TIPSO O Me BnO O O O
H O BnO Me OBn 0OAc O OBn O 0 O OBn BnM 0 Et3S'O OBn _(; O BnO Me OBn TIPSO O O Me OBn Y0 OBn Me Me Et OSIO O OBn 00Ac CI3Cu O 3 OBn Me O
II 14 BnO 15 MAIL
[00309] O-Triisopropylsilyl (2-O-benzyl-[3,4,6-tri-O-benzyl-2-O-triisopropylsilyl-(3-D-glucopyranosyl-(1 =3)]-{ [5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(1 =3)]-2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1-'4)]}-a-L-rhamnopyranoside-[1-+2])-4-O-acetyl-[4-0-benzyl-2,3-di-0-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranose-(1 =3)]-p-D-fucopyranoside (15).
Dichloromethane (1.5 mL) was added to disaccharide 10 (18 mg, 0.028 mmol, 2.8 equiv), imidate 14 (16 mg, 0.0 10 mmol, 1.0 equiv), and 4 A molecular sieves (40 mg), and the resulting mixture was stirred for 30 min at 23 C and was then cooled to -15 C. A
solution of trimethylsilyl trifluoromethanesulphonate (0.145 L, 0.000799 mmol, 0.0783 equiv) in dichloromethane (20 L) was added. After 40 min triethylamine (60 L) was added, and the reaction mixture was filtered, concentrated, and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene/ethyl acetate 97:3) to afford 15 (13 mg, 62% yield). 'H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.46-7.42 (m, 2H), 7.37-7.07 (m, 43H), 5.90 (s, 1H), 5.72 (s, 1H), 5.26 (d, J= 2.0 Hz, 1H), 5.09 (s, 1H), 4.92-4.76 (m, 5H), 4.71 (d, J= 11.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-),4.65 (d, J=
12.0 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.62-4.36 (m, 11H), 4.18 (m, 1H), 4.08 (m, 2H), 3.96-3.82 (m, 5H), 3.73 (m, 1H), 3.67 (dd, J= 10.0, 6.5 Hz, 1H), 3.64-3.48 (m, 5H), 3.42-3.34 (m, 2H), 3.34-3.26 (m, 3H), 3.24-3.16 (m, 2H), 3.12 (dd, J= 9.5, 7.0 Hz, 1H), 2.11 (s, 3H), 1.34-1.24 (m, 9H), 1.18-1.02 (m, 21H), 0.84-0.74 (m, 9H), 0.64-0.54 (m, 6H); '3C NMR (125 MHz, CDC13) 6 171.0, 139.2, 138.7, 138.2, 136.9, 129.8, 129.4, 128.8, 128.65, 128.55, 128.43, 128.38, 128.2, 128.04, 128.00, 127.84, 127.78, 127.75, 127.66, 127.61, 127.4, 127.3, 127.1, 109.3, 107.3, 106.4, 97.0, 91.7, 87.2, 80.4, 79.0, 78.7, 78.5, 77.1, 76.8, 76.4, 75.56, 75.4, 74.6, 74.0, 73.7, 73.4, 73.0, 72.8, 71.3, 65.7, 63.9, 41.6, 29.9, 28.0, 26.2, 21.1, 18.8, 18.4, 18.3, 17.8, 16.5, 12.87, 7.3, 5.5;
FTIR (neat film) 2930, 127 of 205 2868, 1744, 1068 cm'; LRMS (MALDI) in/z: Calcd for Cii7H150O27Si2 (M+Na) 2065.98, found 2066.60.

H Ph H Ph BnO BnO
(1 OBn O
OBn O O
BnO Me BnO Me O O OBn OBn O O OBn OBn Et 3i0 O OBn HN
CI C O Et - O OBn TIPSO O O Me OBn s OBn O O Me OOAc Me BnOO O 15 BnMe O 16 Me Me O
Me Y
[00310] O-Trichloroacetimidoyl (2-O-benzyl-[3,4,6-tri-O-benzyl-2-O-triisopropylsilyl-(3-D-glucopyranosyl-(1 =3)]-} [5-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-benzylidene-(3-D-apiofuranosyl-(1 =3)]-2,4-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl-(1 =4)] }-a-L-rhamnopyranoside- [1 =2])-4-O-acetyl-[4-O-benzyl-2,3-di-O-isopropylidene-a-L-rhamnopyranose-(1=3)]- a-D-fucopyranoside 17. To a solution of 15 (10.0 mg, 0.00489 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (1.50 mL) at 0 C was added tetrabutylammonium fluoride solution (0.0245 M in tetrahydrofuran, 0.20 mL, 0.0049 mmol, 1.0 equiv). After 50 min, the solvent was removed in vacuo at 0 C to give a pale yellow oil that was immediately subjected to further reaction. Rf = 0.42 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1).
The hemiacetal residue was dried by azeotropic removal of water with toluene (3 x 1 mL) and was then dissolved in dichloromethane (4.0 mL) and cooled to 0 C.
Trichloroacetonitrile (74 L, 0.74 mmol, 150 equiv) and 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene (2.7 L, 0.020 mmol, 4.0 equiv) were added, and the solution was stirred at 0 C for 13.5 h and 23 C
for 2 h. The solution was then concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene/ethyl acetate 99:1 to 9:1) to afford 16 (8.3 mg, 0.0041 mmol, 84% yield). Rf= 0.53 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1);'H
NMR (500MHz, CDC13) 6 8.54 (s, 1H, C=NH), 7.49-6.95 (m, 45H), 6.41 (d, J= 3.5 Hz, 1H), 5.90 (s, 1H), 5.68 (s, 1H), 5.28-5.20 (m, 2H), 5.04 (d, J= 11.9 Hz, 1H), 4.92 (d, J= 11.9 Hz, 1H), 4.87-4.64 (m, 3H), 4.84 (d, J= 11.7 Hz, 1H), 4.83 (d, J= 11.7 Hz, 1H), 4.68 (d, J= 10.9 Hz, 1H), 4.64-4.39 (m, 11H), 4.32 (s, 1H), 4.28-4.19 (m, 3H), 4.19-4.08 (m, 3H), 3.91-3.78 (m, 4H), 3.78-3.61 (m, 3H), 3.57-3.33 (m, 6H), 3.30 (m, 1H), 3.23-3.09 (m, 3H), 2.16 (s, 3H, -128 of 205 C(O)CH3), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.32-1.23 (m, 1OH), 1.14 (d, J= 6.5 Hz, 3H), 1.12 (s, 3H), 0.85 (t, J=
7.8 Hz, 9H), 0.66-0.56 (m, 6H); FTIR (neat film) 2932, 2875, 1746, 1673, 1497, 1454, 1367, 1229, 1098, 1072, 990, 735, 698 cm 1; LRMS (MALDI) in/z: Calcd for C1 ioH13oC13NO27NC13SiNa (M+Na) 2055.64, found 2055.73.

H Ph BnO 000 0 OH O OBn Me Me H O
Bn02C Me 4 H BnO Me BnO~~ t3Si0o O HN O O OBn OBn BnO O O CHO H Me O ' OiOOBn Bn0 OBV_C H H Et3Si Me Me CI3C O Et3SiO H Ph 11 OBn BnO SiEt3 OOMe gnp Op Bn18 OOAc O OBn BnOe 0 16 O
YO O BnO Me OBn M
e Me Et3SSi O OBn OBn O O__~ OBn O O Me Bn02C Me Me Me H OOAc O Et SiOjj~ H
BBno ~O Me O
BnO O O CHO H Me O ''Me Bn0 O
BnO OBno H H Et3Si Me YO
BnO, SiEt3 Me Me BnO S13
[00311] Fully-protected synthetic QS-7-Api (S13). A solution of boron trifluoride diethyl etherate (0.40 L, 0.0032 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in dichloromethane (20 L) was injected to a solution of the imidate 16 (6.4 mg, 0.0031 mmol, 1.0 equiv), 18 (9.1 mg, 0.0047 mmol, 1.5 equiv) and 4A molecular sieves (20 mg) in dichloromethane (2.0 mL) at -78 C.
The reaction temperature was allowed to warm to 23 C slowly, and triethylamine (20 L) was added after 16.5 h. The reaction was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexanes/ethyl acetate 4:1) to afford S13 (8.5 mg, 0.0022 mmol, 71 % yield) and starting material 18 (3.0 mg, 0.0016 mmol, 33% recovered). Rf= 0.67 (benzene/ethyl acetate 7:3);
characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.41 (s, 1H, -CHO), 5.94 (s, 1H), 5.83 (s, 1H), 5.30 (d, J
7.3 Hz, 1H), 5.23 (m, 1H), 5.23 (d, J= 12.4 Hz, 1H), 5.13 (d, J= 12.4 Hz, 1H), 5.08 (s, 1H), 129 of 205 5.01 (m, 1 H), 4.31 (t, J = 6.6 Hz, 1 H), 4.22 (m, 1 H), 4.17 (d, J = 7.1 Hz, 1 H), 4.12 (q, J = 7.1 Hz, 1H), 2.96 (m, 1H), 2.83 (m, 1H), 2.72 (m, 1H), 2.50 (m, 1H), 2.09 (s, 3H, -C(O)CH3), 1.39 (s, 3H, Me), 1.30 (s, 3H, Me), 1.12 (s, 3H, Me); see proton NMR below; MS (MALDI) in/z: Calcd for C222H284O46Si4Na (M+Na) 3821 ( 2), found 3820 ( 2).

H Ph Bn0 00 O OBn O
S13 BnO Me O OBn O~ OBn Et3Si0 0Bn OH
O O OBn HO HO O OH
Me O_ O
O Me Me H O
Bn02C Me H Ac 0 Bn0_ OR~ Et3Si0_o _O Me O
BnO BnO CHO H Me O Me Bn0 HO Me OH
n0 OBVC 0 H H Et3Si~ Me A0 0 O 0 OH
Bn0 SiEt3 Me Me H0 OH
BnO Me 0 0 O Me OH
Me H O
HOZC Me H 00 Me Y
HOo H0 0 0 HOMe O I0I
HO CHO H Me HO 'Me OH OH 0 /0 H H Me HO OH
HO\ H
~ QS-7-Api (1) HO
[00312] Synthetic QS-7-Api (1). Two solutions of fully-protected QS-7-Api S13 (1.3 mg, 0.00034 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in dichloromethane (0.20 mL) were each transferred to a 10-mL round bottom flask and cooled to 0 C. A pre-cooled (0 C) solution of trifluoroacetic acid (1.0 mL, TFA/water 4:1) was added to each flask. After vigorous stirring for 60 min, the reaction mixtures were concentrated in vacuo for 140 min at 0 C to give a white solid residue.
To both flasks were added tetrahydrofuran (1.0 mL), ethanol (2.0 mL), and 10%
(dry basis) palladium on carbon, wet, Degussa type E l0l NE/W (2.0 mg, 0.00094 mmol, 2.8 equiv). The two runs were stirred under hydrogen pressure (50 psi) for 44 h, and then the suspensions were combined and filtered through a 0.45 m polyvinylidene fluoride filter disk, which was then washed with methanol (5 mL). The filtrate and rinsing were concentrated and purified by RP-HPLC on an XBridge Prep BEH300 C18 column (5 m, 10 x 250 mm) using a linear gradient of 32-37% acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 30 min at a flow rate of 5 mL/min. The fraction containing the major peak (tR = 14.85 min) was collected and lyophilized 130 of 205 to dryness to afford synthetic QS-7-Api (1) (0.9 mg, 0.0005 mmol, 70% yield) as a white solid.
iH NMR (500 MHz, 7:3 D20:CD3CN) 6 9.36 (s, 1H, -CHO), 5.39 (d, J= 8.0 Hz, 1H), 5.34 (m, 1 H, R2C=CHR), 5.22 (d, J = 3.1 Hz, 1 H), 5.12 (d, J = 2.9 Hz, 1 H), 5.03 (s, 1 H), 4.8 6 (s, 1 H), 4.67 (d, J= 7.7 Hz, 1H), 4.63 (d, J= 7.8 Hz, 1H), 4.55 (d, J= 7.7 Hz, 1H), 4.50 (d, J= 7.7 Hz, 1 H), 4.33 (m, 1 H), 4.05 (d, J = 10.1 Hz, 1 H), 4.02 (m, 1 H), 3.99-3.94 (m, 2H), 3.92-3.57 (m, 22H), 3.55-3.45 (m, 7H), 4.33 (m, 1H), 3.42-3.15 (m, 12H), 2.86 (dd, J= 14.5, 3.6 Hz, 1H), 2.14 (s, 3H, -C(O)CH3), 1.89-1.30 (m, 14H), 1.28 (s, 3H, Me), 1.22 (d, J= 6.2 Hz, 3H, Me), 1.15 (d, J
= 6.1 Hz, 3H, Me), 1.08 (s, 3H, Me), 1.05 (m, 1H), 1.02 (m, 1H), 0.99 (d, J=
6.3 Hz, 3H, Me), 0.93 (s, 3H, Me), 0.89 (s, 3H, Me), 0.84 (s, 3H, Me), 0.71 (s, 3H, Me).
[00313] Natural QS-7-Api (1). Brenntag Quil-A (205 mg, batch L77-244) was fractionated by RP-HPLC on an XBridge Prep C18 OBD column (5 m, 19 x 150 mm) using a linear gradient of 30-40% acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 30 min at a flow rate of 15 mL/min. Crude natural QS-7-Api (1) (tR = 15.25 min) was collected and further purified on an XBridge Prep BEH300 C18 column (5 m, 10 x 250 mm) using a linear gradient of 32-37% acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 30 min at a flow rate of 5 mL/min. The fraction containing QS-7-Api (1) (tR = 14.85 min) was collected and lyophilized to dryness to afford natural QS-7-Api (1) (2.0 mg) as a white solid (-70% pure by iH NMR).

131 of 205 Preparation of the Semisynthetic Triterpene-Trisaccharide O OH
O Me Me H
HO Me OTESO O H
O
T E S ( CHO H Me O 'Me TESO OTEo O H H TES Me TESONy O S14 ,OTES
TESO
Quil A +
O OH
O Me Me H
HO Me H
TESO O O
TESO O OTES O HCHOH H Me O Me O OB~II TES Me TESO Me OTES
[00314] O-(16-O-triethylsilyl-quillaic acid) 4-O-triethylsilyl-[(2,3,4-tri-O-triethylsilyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl)-(1-'3)]-[(2,3,4,6-tetra-O-triethylsilyl-(3-D-galactopyranosyl-(1-'2)]-(3-D-glucuronoside (S14) and O-(16-O-triethylsilyl-quillaic acid) 4-O-triethylsilyl-[(2,3,4-tri-O-triethylsilyl-a-L-rhamnopyranosyl)-(1-'3)]-[(2,3,4,6-tetra-O-triethylsilyl-(3-D-galactopyranosyl-(1-'2)]-(3-D-glucuronoside (S16). A mixture of Brenntag Quil A (1.15 g, batch L77-244) and potassium hydroxide (0.97 g) in ethanol (25 mL) and water (25 mL) was heated at 80 C for 7.25 h, then cooled to 0 C and neutralized with 1 N
aqueous NaOH. The reaction mixture was concentrated to one-half volume and purified by silica gel chromatography (chloroform/methanol/water/acetic acid 15:9:2:1). The major product spot by TLC was isolated, concentrated, and dried by azeotropic removal of solvents with toluene (2 x 20 mL) and lyophilization from water (4 x 30 mL) to afford a mixture of prosapogenins as a light tan foam (0.576 g). Rf = 0.44 (chloroform/methanol/water/acetic acid 15:9:2:1);
characteristic resonances from iH NMR: (500 MHz, CD3OD) 6 9.44 (s, 1H, -CHO), 5.33 (m, 1H, R2C=CHR), 4.80 (d, J=
7.4 Hz, 1H), 4.63 (d, J= 7.7 Hz, 1H), 4.43 (s, 1H), 4.37 (d, J= 6.9 Hz, 1H);
iH NMR (500 MHz, 7:3 D20:CD3CN) 6 9.36 (s, 1H, -CHO), 5.29 (m, 1H, R2C=CHR), 4.68 (d, J= 7.7 Hz, 1H), 4.59 (d, J= 8.2 Hz, 1H).
[00315] Pyridine (8 mL) was added to the prosapogenin (0.560 g), and the suspension was concentrated. Additional pyridine (8.6 mL) was added, followed by triethylsilyl trifluoromethanesulfonate (1.98 mL, 8.76 mmol). Further triethylsilyl trifluoromethanesulfonate was added to the reaction after 66 h (0.33 mL, 1.5 mmol), 89 h (66 L, 0.29 mmol), and 112 h 132 of 205 (0.13 mL, 0.54 mmol). After 5 d, the reaction mixture was concentrated and passed through a plug of silica gel (hexane/ethyl acetate 4:1 to 7:3) to give a light yellow oil that was then dissolved in methanol (10 mL) and tetrahydrofuran (10 mL). The solution was stirred for 3.5 d, and then it was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 4:1 to 7:3) to afford diacid S14 (0.257 g) and diacid S16 (0.095 g) as white solids.
[00316] S14 Rf = 0.39 (benzene/ethyl acetate 4:1);'H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.63 (s, 1H, -CHO), 5.33 (m, 1H, R2C=CHR), 4.54 (m, 1H), 4.50 (d, J= 7.3 Hz, 1H), 4.44 (d, J= 5.9 Hz, 1H), 4.39 (d, J= 7.4 Hz, 1H), 3.95-3.87 (m, 4 H), 3.83-3.78 (m, 2H), 3.74 (t, J= 9.0 Hz, 1H), 3.65-3.58 (m, 3H), 3.48 (m, 1H), 3.43-3.31 (m, 3H), 3.25 (t, J= 7.9 Hz, 1H), 3.12 (t, J= 10.8 Hz, 1H), 2.95 (dd, J= 13.9, 3.7 Hz, 1H), 2.20 (t, J= 13.3 Hz, 1H), 1.91-1.04 (m, 23 H), 1.34 (s, 3H, Me), 1.23 (s, 3H, Me), 1.04-0.91 (m, 86H), 0.89 (s, 3H, Me), 0.80-0.54 (m, 56H); '3C NMR
(125.77 MHz, CDC13) 6 212.12, 183.57, 174.57, 143.28, 122.32, 103.27, 101.72, 101.27, 86.07, 78.98, 78.88, 76.68, 76.45, 76.04, 75.99, 75.28, 74.99, 65.56, 60.44, 54.06, 49.52, 49.02, 46.47, 46.33, 41.56, 40.36, 39.76, 38.02, 36.29, 35.31, 34.85, 32.78, 32.43, 31.66, 30.61, 26.67, 25.14, 24.42, 23.42, 20.41, 17.05, 15.93, 12.15, 7.66, 7.55, 7.36, 7.25, 7.07, 6.98, 6.91, 6.04, 5.81, 5.59, 5.50, 5.42, 5.40, 5.15, 4.58; FTIR (neat film) 2953, 2912, 2877, 1722, 1460, 1414, 1378, 1239, 1163, 1103, 1007, 973, 825, 801, 738 cm'; LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for Cio,H198O20Si9Na (M+Na+) 2006.2, found 2006.5.
[00317] S16 Rf= 0.74 (benzene/ethyl acetate 4:1); characteristic resonances from 'H
NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.39 (s, 1H), 5.33 (s, 1H), 5.02 (d, J= 2.2, 1H), 4.60 (s, 1H), 4.51 (s, 1H), 4.46 (m, 1H), 4.25 (d, J= 7.3, 1H), 4.15 (d, J= 6.7, 1H), 3.92 (s, 1H), 3.83 (d, J= 5.6, 1H), 3.77 (s, 1H), 3.55 (m, 1H), 3.37 (d, J= 8.7, 1H), 3.28 (m, 1H), 2.93 (dd, J=
14.0, 3.7, 1H), 2.20 (m, 1H), 1.36 (s, 3H), 1.17 (d, J= 6.2, 3H), 1.14 (s, 3H), 0.89 (s, 3H); '3C
NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 143.35, 122.24, 102.81, 99.43, 97.18, 82.71, 77.86, 76.28, 75.83, 74.84, 74.05, 73.68, 73.09, 71.62, 70.85, 70.49, 60.71, 54.47, 48.98, 48.43, 46.53, 41.54, 40.85, 39.83, 38.06, 36.82, 36.10, 35.31, 34.81, 32.83, 32.32, 31.34, 30.66, 26.64, 24.45, 23.60, 20.50, 18.42, 16.92, 16.12, 10.88, 7.42, 7.38, 7.30, 7.23, 7.20, 7.17, 7.11, 7.04, 6.95, 5.62, 5.57, 5.47, 5.45, 5.40, 5.23, 5.15, 5.11, 4.62; FTIR (neat film) 2953, 2913, 2876, 1724, 1459, 1414, 1379, 1240, 1108, 1006, 974, 909, 885, 856, 821, 779, 738 cm'; LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for Cio2H2oo02oSi9Na (M+Na+) 2020.3, found 2020.3.
133 of 205 O OH O OH
Me H Me Me HOZC Me Me H Bn02C Me H
Et Si0--V-0, Et3SiO---~_O p Et Si0 O Et3SiO O p H
E3t3Si0 Et Si0 Et S0 O HCHOH H Me O 'Me E3t3SiO0O CHO H Me O 'Me H H Et3Si Me 3 3 Et3Si Me Et3SiO Et3SiO VC
Et SIO
3 OSIEt3 Et3Sl0 SIEt3 Et3SIO S14 Et3SiO 21
[00318] O-(16-O-triethylsilyl-quillaic acid) 4-O-triethylsilyl-[(2,3,4-tri-O-triethylsilyl-(3-D-xylopyranosyl)-(1-'3)]-[(2,3,4,6-tetra-O-triethylsilyl-(3-D-galactopyranosyl-(1-'2)]-(3-D-glucuronoside benzyl ester (21). To a solution of S14 (81.3 mg, 0.0409 mmol, 1.00 equiv), tri-t-butylpyridine (102 mg, 0.412 mmol, 10.1 equiv) and pyridine (30 L, 0.37 mmol, 9.1 equiv) in dichloromethane (0.68 mL) was added benzyl chloroformate (15 L, 0.11 mmol, 2.6 equiv).
After 6 h, additional benzyl chloroformate (3.0 L, 0.021 mmol, 0.51 equiv) was added to the reaction. After stirring for 20 h, the reaction was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene/ethyl acetate 1:0 to 24:1) to afford 21 (58.0 mg, 0.00279 mmol, 68%
yield) as a white solid. Rf = 0.69 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1); (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.70 (s, 1H, -CHO), 7.40-7.27 (m, 5H, aromatic), 5.34 (m, 1H, R2C=CHR), 5.28 (d, J= 12.5 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 5.09 (d, J= 12.3 Hz, 1H, PhCH2-), 4.55 (d, J= 7.6 Hz, 1H), 4.53 (m, 1H), 4.42 (d, J= 7.3 Hz, 1H), 4.12 (d, J= 7.6 Hz, 1H), 3.97-3.71 (m, 8H), 3.64-3.53 (m, 3H), 3.48 (m, 1H), 3.39 (dd, J=
9.3, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 3.37-3.31 (m, 2H), 3.25 (t, J= 8.0 Hz, 1H), 3.12 (t, J= 10.9 Hz, 1H), 2.94 (dd, J= 14.0, 3.7 Hz, 1H), 2.21 (t, J= 13.7 Hz, 1H), 1.93-1.04 (m 20H), 1.35 (s, 3H, Me), 1.30 (s, 3H, Me), 1.04-0.84 (m, 90H), 0.84-0.53 (m, 56H), see proton NMR below; 13C NMR
(125.77 MHz, CDC13) 6 212.59, 182.49, 168.53, 143.44, 135.45, 128.62, 128.43, 128.29, 122.31, 103.63, 101.55, 101.01, 86.22, 79.02, 78.90, 76.61, 76.25, 76.02, 75.27, 75.12, 72.79, 72.67, 71.59, 71.22, 66.98, 65.51, 60.47, 54.05, 49.58, 48.90, 46.52, 46.31, 41.61, 40.35, 39.76, 38.07, 36.28, 35.31, 34.78, 32.81, 32.49, 31.68, 30.63, 26.68, 25.47, 24.45, 23.43, 20.40, 16.97, 15.86, 12.29, 7.69, 7.59, 7.38, 7.27, 7.12, 6.99, 6.92, 6.07, 5.81, 5.61, 5.53, 5.51, 5.43, 5.40, 5.16, 4.58; FTIR
(neat film) 2954, 2914, 2877, 1754, 1723, 1705, 1459, 1414, 1379, 1240, 1170, 1103, 1073, 1007, 972, 825, 801, 739 cm-1 ; LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for Cio8H2o402oSi9Na (M+Na+) 2096.3, found 2096.7.

134 of 205 H Ph O
Bno 000 O OBn Me Me H Bno Me OBn BnOZC Me H HN O O O OBn Et S'S120 0 Et3S0 O OBn j Ph Et O H Me O 'Me C13C O Et3S OBn 3Si0 CH
Et3SiO Et3Si H H Et3Si~ Me O Me BnO Ot Et3SiO OSiEt3 21 `OOAc O OBn Et3SiO Me O 16 O
Bno YO Bno Me OBn O O OBn M
e Me Et 0 OBn O O O O OBn Me H
BnO2C Me Me Me OAc O EtSiO~0 _O H Me O
Et SiO ~~
Et3SiO O CHO H Me O 'Me Bno Et3SiO Et3SiO O O H H Et3Si~ Me OYO
Et3SiO OSiEt3 S15 M e Me Et3SiO
[00319] Fully-protected semisynthetic QS-7-Api (S15). A solution of boron trifluoride diethyl etherate (0.50 L, 0.0040 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in dichloromethane (20 L) was added to a solution of the imidate 16 (8.3 mg, 0.0041 mmol, 0.98 equiv) and 21 (12.7 mg, 0.00612 mmol, 1.50 equiv) in dichloromethane (0.50 mL) with 4A molecular sieves (86 mg) at -78 C. The reaction temperature was allowed to warm to 23 C slowly, and triethylamine (2.8 L) was added after 14.5 h. The reaction was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (silica pretreated with 0.1 % triethylamine in benzene, then benzene/ethyl acetate 99:1 to 24:1) to afford S15 (8.5 mg, 0.0033 mmol, 80% yield). Rf = 0.52 (benzene/ethyl acetate 19:1);
characteristic resonances from iH NMR: (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.69 (s, 1H, -CHO), 7.49-7.04 (m, 50H, aromatic), 5.94 (s, 1H), 5.83 (s, 1H), 5.31 (d, J= 7.2 Hz, 1H), 5.29-5.23 (m, 2H), 5.12-5.06 (m, 2H), 5.01 (s, 1H), 4.93 (d, J= 11.9 Hz, 1H), 4.91-4.44 (m, 19H), 4.42 (d, J= 7.3 Hz, 1H), 4.37 (d, J= 4.7 Hz, 1H), 4.35 (d, J= 3.9 Hz, 1H), 4.23 (dd, J= 2.5, 8.7 Hz, 1H), 4.19 (d, J= 7.3 Hz, 1H), 4.10-4.07 (m, 2H), 3.98-3.43 (m, 2H), 3.43-3.29 (m, 7H), 3.29-3.08 (m, 6H), 2.97 (dd, J
= 13.8, 3.5 Hz, 1H), 2.83 (bs, 1H), 2.73 (bs, 1H), 2.10 (s, 3H, -C(O)CH3), 1.54 (s, 3H, Me), 1.40 (s, 3H, Me), 1.30 (s, 3H, Me), 1.12 (s, 3H, Me); see proton NMR below; 13C NMR
(125.77 MHz, CDC13) 6 212.57, 176.57, 170.56, 168.54, 142.90, 139.36, 139.17, 138.90, 138.61, 138.14, 135 of 205 138.02, 136.90, 135.46, 128.82, 128.61, 128.54, 128.43, 128.36, 128.32, 128.27, 128.21, 128.07, 127.91, 127.80, 127.69, 127.62, 127.56, 127.43, 127.39, 127.24, 127.04, 109.06, 107.31, 106.46, 103.64, 101.91, 101.75, 101.56, 101.00, 99.70, 99.54, 93.81, 91.69, 87.28, 86.19, 84.99, 82.50, 80.58, 79.16, 79.02, 78.90, 78.51, 76.61, 76.35, 76.24, 76.00, 75.72, 75.44, 75.28, 74.82, 74.67, 74.41, 73.69, 73.34, 73.07, 72.96, 72.86, 72.79, 72.66, 72.52, 71.57, 71.23, 70.26, 68.92, 68.48, 66.96, 65.61, 63.99, 60.45, 54.05, 49.58, 48.92, 46.67, 46.26, 41.56, 40.14, 38.19, 36.20, 34.50, 33.07, 32.68, 30.79, 29.85, 28.23, 26.68, 26.50, 25.51, 24.74, 23.61, 22.85, 20.95, 20.44, 18.53, 17.83, 17.68, 16.67, 16.06, 14.27, 12.36, 7.76, 7.60, 7.39, 7.30, 7.27, 7.11, 6.99, 6.92, 6.07, 5.80, 5.60, 5.52, 5.43, 5.40, 5.17, 4.58; FTIR (neat film) 2953, 2935, 2914, 2877, 1747, 1456, 1377, 1239, 1239, 1172, 1100, 1008, 824, 735, 697 cm i.

H Ph BnO O
O OBn O
BnO Me S15 0 OO OBn OBn Et3Si/OBn O O Me Me Me 0 H 0 OBn Bn02C Me H OOAc HO OH
Et Sio0 Et3S0 O Me O HO
E3t3Si0 CHO H Me 0 'Me BnO
Et3SiO Et3SiVC H H Et3Si~ Me OO O OH
Et3SiO SiEt3 Me Me O
Et3S'O 0 Me OOH OH
HO
HO OH
O O O Me OH
Me Me H O
HOZC O Me H O0 Me O HO
HHOO O CHO H Me HO 'MeHOe O 0 OH OHO O H H Me HO OH
HOWL C H
~ QS-7-Api (1) HO
[00320] Semisynthetic QS-7-Api (1). A solution of fully-protected semisynthetic QS-7-Api S15 (1.1 mg, 0.00028 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (1.0 mL) and ethanol (1.0 mL) in a 10-mL round-bottom flask was charged with 10% (dry basis) palladium on carbon, wet, Degussa type E101 NE/W (2.2 mg, 0.00094 mmol, 3.7 equiv). The reaction suspension was stirred under hydrogen pressure (50 psi) for 15 h and then was filtered through a 0.45 m 136 of 205 polyvinylidene fluoride filter disk. The filter was washed with methanol (4 mL), and the filtrate and rinsing were concentrated in a 25-mL round bottom flask to give a clear residue.
The reaction flask was cooled to 0 C and charged with a pre-cooled (0 C) solution of trifluoroacetic acid (1.0 mL, TFA/water 1:1). After stirring for 95 min, the reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo at 0 C. The resulting white solid residue was purified by RP-HPLC on an XBridge Prep BEH300 C18 column (5 m, 10 x 250 mm) using a linear gradient of 32-37%
acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 30 min at a flow rate of 5 mL/min. The fraction containing the major peak (tR = 14.85 min) was collected and lyophilized to dryness. A
total of three deprotection runs were performed on S15 (3.3 mg, 0.00084 mmol) to afford semisynthetic QS-7-Api (1) (1.2 mg, 0.00064 mmol, 77% yield) as a white solid.
'H NMR (500 MHz, 7:3 D20:CD3CN) 6 9.36 (s, 1H, -CHO), 5.39 (d, J= 8.0 Hz, 1H), 5.34 (m, 1H, R2C=CHR), 5.22 (d, J= 3.1 Hz, 1H), 5.12 (d, J= 2.9 Hz, 1H), 5.03 (s, 1H), 4.86 (s, 1H), 4.67 (d, J= 7.7 Hz, 1H), 4.63 (d, J= 7.8 Hz, 1H), 4.55 (d, J= 7.7 Hz, 1H), 4.50 (d, J=
7.7 Hz, 1H), 4.33 (m, 1H), 4.05 (d, J= 10.1 Hz, 1H), 4.02 (m, 1H), 3.99-3.94 (m, 2H), 3.92-3.57 (m, 22H), 3.55-3.45 (m, 7H), 4.33 (m, 1H), 3.42-3.15 (m, 12H), 2.86 (dd, J= 14.5, 3.6 Hz, 1H), 2.14 (s, 3H, -C(O)CH ), 1.89-1.30 (m, 14H), 1.28 (s, 3H, Me), 1.22 (d, J= 6.2 Hz, 3H, Me), 1.15 (d, J=
6.1 Hz, 3H, Me), 1.08 (s, 3H, Me), 1.05 (m, 1H), 1.02 (m, 1H), 0.99 (d, J= 6.3 Hz, 3H, Me), 0.93 (s, 3H, Me), 0.89 (s, 3H, Me), 0.84 (s, 3H, Me), 0.71 (s, 3H, Me).

Example 2
[00321] This Example demonstrates that certain methods described above for Example 1 are applicable to substrates that differ in chemical structure.

137 of 205 Me Me OTBS~O Me OTBS O Me O OH OTBS
0 Me Me H Bn00 O O
H Ph ~O`TES0~0 Me L H + OMe 0~0 TBSO OTBS
T TE OTES O HCHOH Me S 0N1e Me OC(NH)CC13 0 1LOBn BnO
TESO\ OTES 139 O 0 O OBn oil TESO O Me Me Me Me Me OTBS O Me OTBS O Me Bn00 O O OTBS
.0 H Ph O O O Me 0~0 TBSO OTBS
O Me Me H
Bn0 Me H O
OTESO 0 O BnOT! rOBn OBn TES O CHO Me O 'Me Oi 0 0 TESO OTESO 0 H H TES Me O Me TESO,y OTES 'Me 140 Me TESO
[00322] Fully protected QS-21-Api (140). A solution of boron trifluoride diethyl etherate (0.49 L, 0.0039 mmol, 0.50 equiv) in dichloromethane (10 L) was added to a solution of imidate 23 (17.6 mg, 0.00780 mmol, 1.00 equiv) and carboxylic acid 139 (24.3 mg, 0.0117 mmol, 1.50 equiv) in dichloromethane (0.260 mL) with 4A molecular sieves (50 mg) at -78 C.
The reaction temperature was allowed to warm to 23 C slowly, and triethylamine (20 L) was added after 16 h. The reaction was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (silica pretreated with 0.2% triethylamine in benzene, then benzene/ethyl acetate 99:1 to 47:3) to afford 140 (13.8 mg, 0.0033 mmol, 42% yield) as a clear film. Rf = 0.42 (benzene/ethyl acetate 19:1);
characteristic resonances from 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.68 (s, 1H), 5.96 (s, 1H), 5.71 (s, 1H), 5.28 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 5.09 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 4.19 (d, J= 7.2, 2H), 2.92 (dd, J= 13.6, 3.7, 1H), 2.23 (t, J= 13.5, 1H), 1.42 (s, 3H), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.29 (s, 3H), 1.26 (s, 3H), 1.22 (s, 3H); 13C
NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 171.03, 170.73, 168.51, 138.25, 138.12, 137.41, 136.92, 135.43, 129.75, 128.65, 128.62, 128.57, 128.54, 128.43, 128.40, 128.29, 128.26, 127.97, 127.93, 127.85, 127.81, 127.62, 127.32, 107.37, 106.52, 91.72, 87.23, 85.97, 84.24, 81.34, 79.22, 79.03, 78.38, 76.62, 76.20, 75.97, 75.28, 74.13, 73.72, 73.41, 73.10, 72.75, 71.92, 71.59, 71.20, 67.00, 63.87, 63.27, 60.43, 54.11, 49.01, 43.58, 41.68, 40.86, 40.04, 39.56, 36.98, 36.30, 32.96, 30.66, 29.88, 27.56, 26.55, 26.12, 26.06, 25.94, 25.90, 25.09, 24.59, 24.23, 18.53, 18.10, 18.04, 18.02, 17.87, 138 of 205 17.74, 17.28, 16.45, 14.66, 14.59, 12.35, 12.12, 7.70, 7.60, 7.53, 7.39, 7.32, 7.30, 7.27, 7.12, 7.04, 6.99, 6.93, 6.07, 5.80, 5.61, 5.53, 5.49, 5.42, 5.40, 5.18, 5.05, 4.58, -4.09, -4.29, -4.36, -4.38, -4.45, -4.57, -4.77, -5.07, -5.17; FTIR (neat film) 2954, 2935, 2877, 1735, 1458, 1380, 1250, 1163, 1096, 1005, 836, 777, 737, 698 cm 1; LRMS (ESI) m/z: Calcd for C221H382O46Si14Na2 (M+2Na++) 2105.2, found 2106.2.

Me Me OTBSsO Me OTBS,O Me BnO0 O O OTBS
H Ph O O 0 O Me O~O TBSO O OTBS
O Me Me H d O
Bn0 Me O T E S O O O H O BnOBn OBn 0 _~' TIESSO TESO OTES O HCHOH H M ESOM,Me e 0 Me O
TESO1~ OTES Me 140 Me TESO Me Me O HO Me O HO Me HOO O O OH
O O 90--11 O O Me HO O OH HO OOH
Me Me H O
HOZ Me H
HO O O OHOHO O OH OH
HO HO HOH O HCHOH Me OMe e HO Me O
HO OH
HO QS-21-Api (4)
[00323] QS-21-Api (4). Three solutions of fully protected second-generation QS-2-Api 140 (3 x 2.0 mg, 0.0014 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (3 x 1.0 mL) and ethanol (3 x 1.0 mL) in three 10-mL round-bottom flasks were charged with 10% (dry basis) palladium on carbon, wet, Degussa type E101 NE/W (3 x 3.8 mg, 0.0054 mmol, 3.7 equiv). The reaction suspensions were stirred under hydrogen pressure (50 psi) for 23 h and then filtered through three 0.45 m polyvinylidene fluoride filter disks. The filters were washed with methanol, and the filtrate and rinsing were concentrated in three 25-mL round bottom flasks to give the partially protected product as a clear residue.
[00324] The reaction flasks were cooled to 0 C and charged with a pre-cooled (0 C) solution of trifluoroacetic acid (3 x 1.0 mL, TFA/water 3:1). After stirring for 75 min, the reaction mixtures were concentrated in vacuo at 0 C. The resulting white solid residue was purified by RP-HPLC on an XBridge Prep BEH300 C18 column (5 m, 10 x 250 mm) using a 139 of 205 linear gradient of 35-45% acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 30 min at a flow rate of 5 mL/min. The fractions containing the major peak (tR = 27.6 min) were collected and lyophilized to afford synthetic QS-21-Api (4) (1.4 mg, 0.00070 mmol, 49%
yield) as a white solid. LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C92H147046 (M-H) 1987.92, found 1988.33. The 'H NMR
spectrum of QS-21-Api (4) was found to be in agreement with the previously reported characterization.

Me Me TBS, 0 0 Me OTBS 0 v e 0 OH BnO O OTBS
O Me 4eH
BnO Me +
0 / Z- OBn TBSO OTBS
TTE O OTE0 HCHOH e IOC(NH)CCI3 00 0 OBn TESO 0 TES Me O Bn0 TESO\ OTES 139 0 02-z n O Me Me Me Me Me OTBS,O Me OTBS,O Me BnOO O pOTBS
O O O Me OBn TBSO -OTBS
0 Me Me H BnO OBn BnO Me H O~/ O
0 O Bn0 0TES0 OOBn TTSo- OTES O HCHOH H Me O 'Me 0 O O
TESO 0 TES Me O Me TESO\ TES 141 Me Me TESO
[00325] Fully protected QS-21-Xyl (141). A solution of boron trifluoride diethyl etherate (0.33 L, 0.0026 mmol, 0.50 equiv) in dichloromethane (10 L) was added to a solution of imidate 126 (12.4 mg, 0.00529 mmol, 1.00 equiv) and carboxylic acid 139 (15.8 mg, 0.00761 mmol, 1.44 equiv) in dichloromethane (0.176 mL) with 4A molecular sieves (62 mg) at -78 C.
The reaction temperature was allowed to warm to 23 C slowly, and triethylamine (20 L) was added after 21 h. The reaction was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (silica pretreated with 0.5% triethylamine in benzene, then benzene/ethyl acetate 99:1 to 97:3:3) to afford 141 in about 77% purity (14.2 mg, 0.0026 mmol, 49% yield) as a clear film. Rf = 0.49 (benzene/ethyl acetate 19:1); characteristic resonances from 'H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.68 (s, 1H), 5.28 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 5.20 (d, J= 1.6, 1H), 5.09 (d, J= 12.3, 1H), 4.97 (m, 1H), 4.94 (d, 140 of 205 J= 11.5, 1H), 4.92 (d, J= 7.8, 1H), 4.47 (d, J= 10.1, 1H), 4.42 (d, J= 7.2, 1H), 4.37 (d, J=
10.7, 1 H), 4.18 (d, J = 7.1, 2H), 3.13 (t, J = 10.8, 1 H), 3.04 (t, J = 10.9, 1 H), 2.92 (dd, J = 14.6, 3.9, 1H), 2.22 (t, J= 13.8, 1H), 1.43 (s, 3H), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.28 (s, 3H), 1.26 (s, 3H), 1.22 (s, 3H);
13C NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 175.39, 171.03, 170.72, 168.51, 143.57, 138.90, 138.87, 138.67, 138.47, 138.38, 137.42, 135.43, 128.62, 128.60, 128.51, 128.48, 128.44, 128.42, 128.34, 128.29, 128.15, 128.12, 128.11, 127.97, 127.78, 127.73, 127.60, 109.74, 107.38, 103.71, 103.28, 102.41, 101.56, 100.99, 93.65, 86.02, 84.20, 84.00, 82.82, 82.79, 79.87, 79.20, 79.03, 78.92, 78.52, 78.35, 76.66, 76.20, 76.00, 75.79, 75.73, 75.26, 75.15, 74.58, 74.45, 73.48, 73.26, 72.81, 72.66, 72.01, 71.58, 71.25, 67.14, 66.96, 66.32, 65.54, 64.03, 63.81, 63.28, 60.40, 54.10, 49.60, 48.99, 46.35, 43.65, 42.79, 41.69, 40.91, 40.02, 39.52, 38.67, 37.00, 36.29, 32.90, 32.71, 30.65, 29.89, 27.58, 26.61, 26.12, 26.06, 25.94, 25.90, 25.72, 25.03, 24.52, 24.23, 18.55, 18.10, 18.07, 18.04, 18.02, 17.62, 17.25, 16.40, 16.05, 14.65, 14.60, 12.35, 12.23, 12.08, 7.70, 7.60, 7.39, 7.32, 7.29, 7.27, 7.12, 6.99, 6.93, 6.07, 5.81, 5.61, 5.53, 5.48, 5.42, 5.18, 5.03, 4.58, -4.08, -4.11, -4.30, -4.36, -4.38, -4.44, -4.57, -4.74, -5.07, -5.17; FTIR (neat film) 2955, 2877, 1735, 1458, 1380, 1250, 1165, 1091, 1006, 837, 777, 735, 698 cm 1; LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C228H390O46Si14Na2 (M+2Na++) 2151.2, found 2151.6.

Me Me OTBS,O Me OTBS,O Me BnOO O O OTBS
O O O O Me OBn TBSO OTBS
O Me Me BnOOBn Bn0 Me O~/~u p^N~~ .p OBOnO O OBn HCHOH H M ES OMeMe OO Me TESO\y TES 141 Me Me Me Me TESO
O HO Me O HO Me OH
HO O O

O O i O Me OH HO OH
Me H H--OH
HO2C Me me O O
HO'~O~ HO~_~ , H O O H HO O OH
HO HO OHIO ~O HCHOH H Me HOM'Me HO Me e HOH
HO~/ QS-21 Xyl (5) 141 of 205
[00326] QS-21-Xyl (5). Three solutions of fully protected second-generation QS-2-Xyl 141 (3 x 2.0 mg, 0.0014 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (3 x 1.0 mL) and ethanol (3 x 1.0 mL) in three 10-mL round-bottom flasks were charged with 10% (dry basis) palladium on carbon, wet, Degussa type E101 NE/W (3 x 3.8 mg, 0.0054 mmol, 3.7 equiv). The reaction suspensions were stirred under hydrogen pressure (50 psi) for 23 h and then filtered through three 0.45 m polyvinylidene fluoride filter disks. The filters were washed with methanol, and the filtrate and rinsing were concentrated in three 25-mL round bottom flasks to give the partially protected product as a clear residue.
[00327] The reaction flasks were cooled to 0 C and charged with a pre-cooled (0 C) solution of trifluoroacetic acid (3 x 1.0 mL, TFA/water 3:1). After stirring for 75 min, the reaction mixtures were concentrated in vacuo at 0 C. The resulting white solid residue was purified by RP-HPLC on an XBridge Prep BEH300 C18 column (5 m, 10 x 250 mm) using a linear gradient of 35-45% acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 30 min at a flow rate of 5 mL/min. The fractions containing the major peak (tR = 27.7 min) were collected and lyophilized to afford synthetic QS-21-Xyl (5) (1.4 mg, 0.00070 mmol, 50%
yield) as a white solid. LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C92H147046 (M-H) 1987.92, found 1987.94. The 'H NMR
spectrum of QS-21-Xyl (5) was found to be in agreement with the previously reported characterization.

Example 3 N3 OBz N3 OBn Bz0 Bn0
[00328] 3,6-Di-O-benzyl-4-azido-4-deoxy-D-galactal (218). Sodium hydroxide (0.115 g, 2.89 mmol, 0.357 equiv) was added to a solution of glycal 221 (2.930 g, 8.063 mmol, 1.000 equiv) in methanol (40 mL) at 0 C, and the reaction was stirred at 23 C.
After 14 h, the reaction was concentrated to a sticky tan solid, and trace solvent was removed by co-evaporation with toluene (7 mL).

142 of 205
[00329] Dimethylformamide (40 mL) was added to the residue, and the resulting brown suspension was cooled to 0 C. Sodium hydride (60% dispersion in oil, 0.977 g, 24.4 mmol, 3.03 equiv) was added to the reaction, followed by benzyl bromide (4.80 mL, 40.3 mmol, 5.01 equiv).
After 3 h, the orange suspension was stirred at 23 C for 16 h. The reaction was quenched with methanol (20 mL), diluted with dichloromethane (100 mL), and washed with water (100 mL).
The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (80 mL), and the combined organic layers were washed with water (100 mL), dried with magnesium sulfate, and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 9:1 to 4:1) to afford 218 (2.199 g, 6.258 mmol, 78%
yield) as a yellow oil. Rf = 0.61 (hexane/ethyl acetate 3:1); 'H NMR (400 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.41 -7.26 (m, 1OH), 6.37 (dd, J= 6.3, 1.9, 1H), 4.83 (dt, J= 6.4, 1.8, 1H), 4.70 (d, J= 12.0, 1H), 4.63 (d, J= 11.9, 1H), 4.61 (d, J= 11.8, 1H), 4.55 (d, J= 11.8, 1H), 4.41 (m, 1H), 4.08 (t, J= 6.6, 1H), 3.97 (m, 1H), 3.70 (dd, J= 6.6, 1.7, 2H; 13C NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 144.69, 137.76, 137.69, 128.68, 128.67, 128.14, 128.09, 128.04, 127.76, 101.00, 74.66, 73.84, 71.57, 70.92, 68.84, 55.39; FTIR (neat film) 3031.5, 2868.5, 2109.9, 1650.9, 1496.5, 1454.2, 1333.0, 1277.3, 1230.7, 1097.1, 1052.8, 1028.2, 735.9, 697.6, 668.1 cm'; HRMS (ESI) in/z:
Calcd for C2oH21N3O3Na (M+Na+) 374.1481, found 374.1479.

N3 OBn N3 OBn -' BnO0Ac Bn0 OAc
[00330] O-Acetyl 2-O-acetyl-4-azido-4-deoxy-3,6-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-galactopyranoside (222). Boron trifluoride diethyl etherate (74.0 L, 0.636 mmol, 0.219 equiv) was added to a solution of glycal 218 (1.020 g, 2.904 mmol, 1.000 equiv) and iodobenzene diacetate (1.119 g, 3.474 mmol, 1.196 equiv) in dichloromethane (36 mL) in a cold bath at -50 C.
After 25 min, the yellow solution was transferred to a cold bath at -25 C and stirred for an additional 30 min.
Triethyl amine (2.0 mL) was added, and the resulting suspension was diluted with dichloromethane (20 mL) and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution (30 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (30 mL), and the combined organic layers were dried with magnesium sulfate and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 4:1 to 3:1) to afford 222 (1.163 g, 2.477 mmol, 85%
yield) as a yellow 143 of 205 solid. Rf = 0.25 (hexane/ethyl acetate 3:1); 'H NMR (400 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.41 -7.28 (m, 1 OH), 5.51 (d, J= 8.3, 1H), 5.30 (dd, J= 9.8, 8.4, 1H), 4.74 (d, J= 12.2, 1H), 4.56 (d, J= 12.3, 1H), 4.54 (s, 2H), 4.08 (dd, J= 3.6, 1.1, 1H), 3.74 (td, J= 6.7, 1.3, 1H), 3.69 (dd, J= 9.8, 3.6, 1H), 3.63 (d, J= 6.8, 2H), 2.06 (s, 3H), 2.00 (s, 3H); '3C NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 169.50, 169.38, 137.51, 137.25, 128.73, 128.69, 128.32, 128.23, 128.20, 127.92, 92.47, 78.73, 73.86, 72.60, 72.23, 69.78, 67.82, 59.10, 20.96, 20.88; FTIR (neat film) 2920.8, 2107.7, 1755.9, 1454.8, 1368.4, 1232.5, 1214.6, 1059.1, 739.3, 698.4 cm'; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C24H27N3O7Na (M+Na+) 492.1747, found 492.1755.

OBn OBn BnOOAc BnO
OAc HO OH
[00331] 4-azido-4-deoxy-3,6-di-O-benzyl-D-galactopyranose (223). Potassium carbonate (0.600 g, 4.34 mmol, 3.99 equiv) was added to a solution of diacetate 222 (0.511 g, 1.09 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in methanol (50 mL) and water (5 mL). After 1.5 h, the yellow solution was decanted from the undissolved potassium carbonate and concentrated to about 4 mL and then diluted with dichloromethane (50 mL) and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution (10 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 10 mL) and the combined organic layers were dried with magnesium sulfate and purified by silica gel chromatography (ethyl acetate) to afford 223 (0.353 g, 0.917 mmol, 84%
yield) as a yellow oil (1:1 a: (3). Rf = 0.17, 014 (hexane/ethyl acetate 1:1); 'H NMR (400 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.43 -7.27 (m, 20H), 5.28 (d, J= 3.8, 1H), 4.78 (d, J= 11.5, 1H), 4.78 (d, J= 11.5, 1H), 4.67 (d, J=
11.5, 1H), 4.68 (d, J= 11.5, 1H), 4.58 (d, J= 11.9, 1H), 4.56 (d, J= 11.9, 1H), 4.52 (d, J= 11.9, 1 H), 4.51 (d, J = 11.9, 1 H), 4.51 (d, J = 7.7, 1 H), 4.21 (td, J = 6.5, 1.1, 1 H), 4.02 (dd, J = 3.4, 1.3, 1H), 3.99 (dd, J= 9.9, 3.8, 2H), 3.85 (dd, J= 9.7, 3.5, 1H), 3.73 (dd, J=
9.5, 7.7, 1H), 3.69-3.51 (m, 6H); '3C NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 137.62, 137.50, 137.48, 128.67, 128.59, 128.16, 128.13, 128.10, 128.09, 128.07, 128.02, 128.00, 97.08, 92.50, 80.85, 78.06, 73.64, 73.61, 72.63, 72.51, 72.14, 71.82, 69.25, 68.76, 68.68, 67.38, 60.27, 59.49; FTIR (neat film) 3401.3, 3032.4, 2921.6, 2105.6, 1454.4, 1367.2, 1279.3, 1095.8, 1028.3, 738.1, 698.0 cm'; HRMS
(ESI) in/z:
Calcd for C20H23N3O5Na (M+Na+) 408.1535, found 408.1535.

144 of 205 N3 OBnn N3 OBn Bn0- \-BnO \ /OTIPS
HO OH OH
[00332] O-triisopropylsilyl 4-azido-4-deoxy-3,6-di-O-benzyl-(3-D-galactopyranoside (224). Triisopropylsilyl chloride (0.63 mL, 3.0 mmol, 1.2 equiv) was added to a solution of hemiacetal 223 (0.959 g, 2.49 mmol, 1.00 equiv), imidazole (0.409 g, 6.01 mmol, 2.41 equiv), and 4-dimethylaminopyridine (29 mg, 0.24 mmol, 0.096 equiv) in dimethylformamide (2.5 mL).
After 19 h, the yellow solution was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 19:1 to 9:1) to afford 224 (0.800 g, 1.48 mmol, 59%
yield) as a colorless oil. Rf = 0.49 (hexane/ethyl acetate 4:1); 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.43 -7.24 (m, 10H), 4.78 (d, J= 11.8, 1H), 4.75 (d, J= 11.8, 1H), 4.55 (d, J= 11.6, 1H), 4.52 (d, J= 12.0, 1H), 4.51 (d, J= 7.3, 1H), 3.98 (d, J= 3.6, 1H), 3.72 (ddd, J= 9.5, 7.3, 2.1, 1H), 3.69 -3.58 (m, 3H), 3.56 (dd, J= 9.6, 3.7, 1H), 2.26 (d, J= 2.2, 1H), 1.19 - 0.99 (m, 21H); '3 C NMR
(126 MHz, CDC13) 6 137.86, 137.84, 128.70, 128.63, 128.08, 128.05, 127.97, 127.93, 98.09, 80.69, 73.81, 73.78, 72.80, 72.01, 68.83, 59.83, 17.96, 17.90, 12.33; FTIR (neat film) 3463.8, 2943.4, 2866.2, 2108.6, 1455.3, 1366.1, 1280.0, 1185.4, 1099.0, 1028.7, 1014.6, 997.6, 883.5, 805.4, 736.3, 695.5, 669.0 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C29H43N3O5SiNa (M+Na+) 564.2870, found 564.2870.

H Ph N3 H Ph OXO BnO OBn OO

TIPSO pn0 OBn + HO O OBOnO O O OBn OBn O OBB O O OBn OBn O Me O Me Me Me Me 'Me
[00333] Azido tetrasaccharide 225. Trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride (70 L, 0.42 mmol, 2.0 equiv) was added to a solution of trisaccharide 81 (0.168 mg, 0.203 mmol, 1.00 equiv), phenyl sulfoxide (173 mg, 0.855 mmol, 4.20 equiv) and 2,4,6-tri-tert-butylpyridine (262 mg, 1.06 mmol, 5.21 equiv) in dichloromethane (20 mL) at -78 C. The reaction stirred in a cold bath at -78 C for 8 min and then was transferred to a bath between -55 and -50 C for 70 min. A solution of pyranoside 224 (137 mg, 0.253 mmol, 1.24 equiv) in dichloromethane (3.0 mL) at -78 C was added via cannula, and the reaction was warmed slowly from -50 C to 0 C

145 of 205 over 4 h and then stirred at 23 C for 45 min. Triethylamine (1.0 mL) was added to the reaction mixture, which was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene/ethyl acetate 49:1 to 9:1) to afford tetrasaccharide 225 (185 mg, 0.137 mmol, 67%
yield) as a clear film. Rf= 0.59 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1); 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.53 -7.18 (m, 30H), 5.95 (s, 1H), 5.67 (s, 2H), 4.89 (d, J= 7.6, 1H), 4.86 (d, J= 11.1, 1H), 4.72 (d, J= 11.6, 1H), 4.63 - 4.47 (m, 8H), 4.44 (d, J= 11.8, 1H), 4.41 (s, 1H), 4.13 (dd, J= 7.5, 5.7, 1H); 4.04 (d, J=
5.6, 1H), 4.01 (dd, J= 3.4, 0.8, 1H), 3.97 - 3.83 (m, 3H), 3.93 (s, 2H), 3.79 (t, J= 9.0, 1H), 3.69 - 3.53 (m, 7H), 3.36 (td, J= 9.6, 5.3, 1H), 3.24 (dd, J= 9.1, 7.6, 1H), 3.14 (dd, J= 11.6, 10.0, 1H), 1.48 (s, 3H), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.23 (d, J= 6.2, 3H), 1.10 - 0.95 (m, 21H);
'3 C NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 138.22, 138.12, 137.76, 137.01, 136.95, 129.72, 128.89, 128.79, 128.74, 128.63, 128.56, 128.52, 128.41, 128.38, 128.32, 128.32, 128.09, 128.01, 127.92, 127.83, 127.75, 127.59, 127.32, 109.15, 107.30, 106.46, 102.56, 97.27, 97.13, 91.65, 87.15, 82.33, 81.20, 78.43, 78.28, 78.49, 76.74, 76.26, 74.06, 73.99, 73.81, 73.66, 73.33, 72.97, 71.74, 71.67, 71.15, 68.68, 64.51, 63.78, 58.89, 27.95, 26.60, 18.07, 17.99, 17.93, 12.43; FTIR (neat film) 2927.8, 2866.8, 2108.8, 1455.1, 1367.0, 1184.5, 1092.1, 990.3, 735.7, 697.8 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) in/z:
Calcd for C76H95N3017SiNa (M+Na+) 1372.6328, found 1382.6343.

N3 H Ph N3 H Ph BnO OBn BnO OBn IVI
O O O O O O O
TIPSO
H
O O BOnO O O OBn OBn O O O O O OBn OBn O Me O Me Me Me Me Me
[00334] Azido tetrasaccharide hemiacetal 226. Tetrabutylammonium fluoride solution (1.0 M in tetrahydrofuran, 14 L, 0.014 mmol, 1.0 equiv) was added to a solution of triisopropylsilyl acetal 225 (18.5 mg, 0.0137 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (1.8 mL) at 0 C. After 17 min, methanol (1.0 mL) was added, and the solvent was removed in vacuo at 0 C
to give a pale yellow oil that was purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene/ethyl acetate 19:1 to 9:1) to afford 226 (15.2 mg, 0.0127 mmol, 93% yield). Rf = 0.61 (benzene/ethyl acetate 4:1); characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 7.54 - 7.20 (m, 30H), 5.96 (s, 1H), 5.69 (s, 1H), 4.87 (dd, J= 12.2, 7.5, 1H), 4.83 (d, J= 11.4, 1H), 4.72 (d, J= 11.7, 1H), 3.38 (m, 1H), 3.26 (m, 1H), 3.16 (m, 1H); FTIR (neat film) 3426.0, 2933.1, 2107.1, 1454.6, 1370.7, 146 of 205 1220.2, 1092.6, 1027.0, 992.4, 735.5, 698.3 cm-1; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C67H75N3017Na (M+Na+) 1216.4994, found 1216.4939.

N
N3 ; Ph BnpIOBn ; Ph O Bn0 OBn O O O O Lp~/J OHO O
O
HO - OC(NH)CCI3 O O O O O O OBn OBn O
O O O O O OBn OBn O Me O Me Me Me Me 'Me
[00335] Azido tetrasaccharide trichloroacetimidate 227. Trichloroacetonitrile (191 L, 1.91 mmol, 150 equiv) and 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene (7.6 L, 0.051 mmol, 4.0 equiv) were added to a solution of hemiacetal 226 (15.2 mg, 0.0127 mmol, 1.00 equiv) at 0 C. After 14 h at 0 C and 45 min at 23 C, the solution was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene/ethyl acetate 19:1 to 4:1) to afford 227 (16.2 mg, 0.0121 mmol, 95%
yield) as a clear film. Rf = 0.50 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1); characteristic peaks from iH NMR
(500 MHz, CDC13) 6 8.52 (s, 1H), 7.59 - 7.14 (m, 30H), 5.95 (s, 1H), 5.67 (s, 1H), 5.23 (s, 1H), 4.88 (d, J= 7.5, 1H), 4.79 (d, J= 10.8, 1H), 4.77 (d, J= 11.2, 1H), 4.67 (d, J= 11.7, 1H), 4.20 (dd, J = 10.0, 3.5, 1 H), 3.83 (dd, J = 11.5, 5.5, 2H), 3.78 (t, J = 9.0, 1 H), 3.33 (m, 1 H), 3.21 (dd, J= 8.9, 7.8, 1H), 3.13 (dd, J= 11.7, 9.9, 1H), 1.21 (d, J= 6.0, 3H); '3C NMR
(126 MHz, CDC13) 6 161.14, 138.18, 138.09, 138.01, 137.63, 137.48, 136.89, 129.76, 128.70, 128.64, 128.56, 128.52, 128.46, 128.39, 128.21, 128.14, 128.11, 128.09, 127.95, 127.92, 127.84, 127.60, 127.31, 110.02, 109.41, 107.24, 106.55, 106.48, 101.83, 99.71, 95.88, 95.45, 91.73, 91.67, 91.19, 87.17, 80.69, 78.23, 77.26, 76.67, 76.60, 76.02, 74.68, 73.83, 73.81, 73.69, 73.36, 73.04, 72.68, 71.13, 69.97, 68.26, 64.96, 63.77, 60.35, 27.88, 26.55, 17.84, 17.60, 12.42; FTIR
(neat film) 3031.0, 2932.9, 2110.8, 1671.8, 1454.8, 1368.6, 1280.7, 1242.2, 1220.8, 1095.6, 1020.2, 991.5, 912.4, 860.5, 795.0, 735.0, 698.1, 677.1 cm 1; HRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C69H75C13N4O17Na (M+Na+) 1359.4091, found 1359.4127.

147 of 205 N
Bn0 Bn H Ph e e H O
BnO Ae O(NH)CCI3 OTESO O H O OBn TE O
OBn SO Me O O
O CHO H Me O ' TESO OTESO O H H S Me +
TESO TE 0 Me OTES Me Me TESO
N3 H Ph 0Bno OBn 0 O
O O
e BnO e e H H 0 0 BnO OBn OBn 0TES0 O O Me TTE 00 CHO H Me O 'Me 7t OTESO 0 H H TES Me Me TESO Me OTES
[00336] Azido saponin 228. Boron trifluoride diethyl etherate (2.0 L, 0.016 mmol, 0.51 equiv) was added to a solution of imidate 227 (41.7 mg, 0.0311 mmol, 1.00 equiv) and carboxylic acid 139 (88.6 mg, 0.0427 mmol, 1.37 equiv) with 4A molecular sieves (147 mg) in dichloromethane (1.04 mL) at -78 C. After 3 min, the reaction flask was transferred to a -43 C
cold bath (11:10 ethanol:water / C02), and the reaction temperature was allowed to warm slowly to 23 C. Triethylamine (0.20 mL) was added after 14.5 h, and the reaction was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (silica pretreated with 0.2%
triethylamine in benzene, then benzene/ethyl acetate 49:1 to 9:1) to afford 228 (83.5 mg, 0.0257 mmol, 82%
yield) as a white solid. Rf = 0.58 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1); characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.68 (s, 1H), 5.95 (s, 1H), 5.70 (s, 1H), 5.17 (d, J= 2.4, 1H), 5.08 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 4.83 (d, J= 11.2, 1H), 4.79 (d, J= 7.6, 1H), 4.71 (d, J= 11.1, 1H), 4.61 (d, J= 11.1, 1H), 4.18 (d, J= 7.3, 1H), 4.11 (dd, J= 6.4, 2.7, 1H), 3.24 (m, 2H), 3.13 (m, 2H), 2.88 (dd, J= 14.1, 3.7, 1H), 2.20 (t, J= 13.5, 1H), 1.40 (s, 3H), 1.32 (s, 3H), 1.29 (s, 3H), 1.22 (s, 3H), 1.15 (d, J= 6.2, 3H), 0.85 (s, 3H); '3C NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 212.45, 175.31, 168.49, 143.39, 138.22, 138.13, 138.09, 137.64, 137.11, 136.89, 135.42, 129.73, 128.70, 128.63, 128.60, 128.57, 128.55, 128.53, 128.43, 128.40, 128.38, 128.27, 128.12, 128.04, 127.98, 127.96, 127.91, 127.83, 127.78, 127.60, 127.30, 121.97, 109.70, 107.32, 106.50, 103.64, 102.30, 101.56, 100.99, 97.96, 93.89, 91.70, 87.20, 86.20, 81.33, 80.93, 78.97, 78.88, 78.77, 78.28, 76.77, 76.58, 75.99, 75.25, 74.12, 73.73, 73.70, 73.37, 73.08, 72.77, 72.68, 72.02, 71.57, 71.20, 71.15, 67.67, 67.60, 66.96, 65.49, 63.81, 60.42, 59.03, 54.06, 49.52, 49.04, 46.75, 46.29, 41.60, 40.83, 39.91, 38.12, 36.23, 35.32, 148 of 205 34.89, 32.87, 32.60, 30.88, 30.57, 29.87, 27.53, 26.50, 25.78, 25.48, 24.44, 23.44, 20.37, 17.73, 17.29, 15.97, 12.30, 7.68, 7.58, 7.47, 7.37, 7.31, 7.27, 7.25, 7.10, 6.97, 6.91, 6.05, 5.79, 5.59, 5.51, 5.48, 5.41, 5.38, 5.14, 5.03, 4.57; FTIR (neat film) 2952.9, 2912.2, 2876.4, 2106.7, 1752.4, 1497.1, 1456.5, 1379.5, 1240.2, 1165.7, 1098.7, 1006.1, 913.3, 863.1, 824.5, 736.4, 697.5 cm';
LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C176H279N3O35Si9Na2 (M+2Na++) 1646.39, found 1648.64.

N3 H Ph OBnO OBn O 0 O
O
O O
O Me BnO-- Me Me H H O O 0 O O OBn OBn TESO OTESOO O O Me TESO CHO H Me O 'Me TESO OTESO O H H TES Me Me Me TESO_~TES 228 TESO
NH2 H Ph OBnO OBn 0&
O
O
O O
~ Me BnMe Me H H O BOnO O O OBn OBn OTESO O O Me TTE OO CHO H Me O 'Me TESO OTESO O H H TES Me Me Me TESO
[00337] Amino saponin 229. A yellow solution of diphenyldiselenide (45.8 mg, 0.147 mmol, 1.00 equiv) and hypophosphorous acid, 50% in water (0.16 mL, 1.6 mmol, 11 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (2.0 mL) was heated at 40 C for 40 min until it turned colorless. The solution was then removed from the heat, diluted with benzene (2.0 mL) and deionized water (2.0 mL).
The lower phase of the resulting biphasic suspension was removed by syringe (2.4 mL), and the remaining organic layer was dried with sodium sulphate.
[00338] This freshly prepared solution of phenylselenol (1.7 mL, -0.14 mmol, 30 equiv) was added to a solution of azido saponin 228 (15.0 mg, 0.00461 mmol, 1.00 equiv) in triethylamine (5.0 mL) and was heated at 30 C for 15 h.
[00339] A second solution of phenylselenol was prepared by heating diphenyldiselenide (53.7 mg, 0.172 mmol, 1.00 equiv) and hypophosphorous acid, 50% in water (0.19 mL, 1.8 mmol, 11 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (2.0 mL) was heated at 40 C for 30 min until it turned colorless. This solution of phenylselenol was then removed from the heat, diluted with benzene (2.0 mL) and deionized water (2.0 mL). The lower phase of the resulting biphasic suspension 149 of 205 was removed by syringe (2.4 mL), and the remaining organic layer was dried with sodium sulphate.
[00340] The second solution of phenylselenol (1.5 mL, -0.14 mmol, 30 equiv) was added to the reaction flask containing azido saponin 228, which was heated at 40 C
for 8 h. Additional phenylselenol solution (0.6 mL, -0.06 mmol, 12 equiv) was added, and the reaction was stirred at 40 C for an additional 2 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene to 3:2 benzene/ethyl acetate) to afford 228 (13.6 mg, 0.00422 mmol, 91 % yield) as a white solid film. Rf = 0.24 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1);
characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.69 (s, 1H), 5.96 (s, 1H), 5.71 (s, 1H), 5.37 (d, J= 7.8, 1H), 5.31 (m, 1H), 5.28 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 5.19 (d, J= 1.7, 1H), 5.09 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 4.83 (d, J=
11.1, 1 H), 4.82 (d, J = 7.5, 1 H), 4.64 (t, J = 10.9, 2H), 4.59 (d, J = 1.8, 2H), 4.18 (d, J = 7.3, 1H), 3.25 (t, J= 8.4, 2H), 3.14 (m, 2H), 2.89 (dd, J= 14.5, 4.0, 1H), 1.42 (s, 3H), 1.33 (s, 3H), 1.29 (s, 3H), 1.24 (s, 3H), 1.16 (d, J= 6.2, 3H); FTIR (neat film) 2952.7, 2912.3, 2876.2, 1753.9, 1453.9, 1097.9, 1006.5, 862.44, 824.6, 737.1, 697.1, 668.4 cm'.

Me Me OTBS,O Me OT,O Me HO H BS O OTBS \~ ~O

NH2 H Ph + BnO OBn O O O
O O
O Me Me H O Bn0 OBn BnC~ Me O 02/ O ~OBn OTESO O O Me TTESOO CHO H Me O 'Me TESO OTESO O H H TES1 Me Me Me TESO\ ' TES 229 Me Me TESO OBSCMe OBS.OMe H N N OTBS

O BnO OBn ;Ph TBSO OTBS
O O O O O
O Me Me H
Bn0 Me OBn H O Bn0 O OBn TESO OTESOO_~O O O
CHO H Me O 'Me O Me TESO TESO OTESO O H H TES Me TESO 248 Me 'Me OTES
TESO
[00341] Fully protected compound 1-9 (248). A solution of ethyl chloroformate (0.45 L, 0.0047 mmol, 1.2 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (10 L) was added to a solution of carboxylic 150 of 205 acid 243 (5.0 mg, 0.0047 mmol, 1.2 equiv) and triethylamine (0.82 L, 0.0059 mmol, 1.5 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (1.0 mL) at 0 C. After 2.5 h, amino saponin 229 (12.7 mg, 0.00394 mmol, 1.00 equiv) was added in a solution of tetrahydrofuran (3.0 mL). The reaction was warmed slowly to 10 C over 12 h and stirred at 10 C for an additional 2 h. The reaction was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate 4:1) to afford 248 (15.6 mg, 0.00365 mmol, 93% yield) as a clear film. Rf= 0.30 (hexane/ethyl acetate 4:1);
characteristic resonances from 'H NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.69 (s, 1H), 6.31 (d, J= 9.0, 1H), 6.25 (d, J= 9.9, 1H), 5.96 (s, 1H), 5.72 (s, 1H), 5.37 (d, J= 7.3, 1H), 5.34 (m, 1H), 5.28 (d, J=
12.4, 1H), 5.18 (s, 1H), 5.09 (m, 1H), 4.85 (d, J= 11.1, 1H), 4.82 (d, J=
10.6, 1H), 4.78 (d, J
7.6, 1 H), 4.37 (d, J = 10.4, 1 H), 4.23 (m, 1 H), 4.18 (d, J = 7.2, 1 H), 3.25 (m, 2H), 3.13 (td, J =
11.2, 3.8, 2H), 2.90 (dd, J= 14.3, 2.8, 1H), 2.22 (t, J= 13.3, 1H), 1.44 (s, 3H), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.29 (s, 3H), 1.20 (s, 3H), 1.11 (d, J= 6.1, 3H); '3C NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 170.74, 170.67, 168.50, 138.25, 138.12, 138.10, 138.01, 137.76, 136.91, 135.44, 129.75, 128.65, 128.62, 128.57, 128.54, 128.48, 128.46, 128.43, 128.40, 128.29, 127.97, 127.92, 127.84, 127.66, 127.62, 127.31, 109.73, 107.38, 107.02, 106.52, 91.72, 87.22, 86.49, 86.21, 84.14, 81.41, 79.17, 76.02, 74.21, 73.72, 73.54, 73.39, 73.12, 71.22, 71.17, 67.74, 66.98, 63.90, 63.85, 63.41, 54.07, 50.12, 48.85, 41.61, 39.88, 38.68, 36.80, 36.26, 32.85, 30.57, 29.85, 27.52, 26.57, 25.67, 25.38, 24.40, 18.56, 18.21, 18.13, 18.06, 18.02, 17.69, 17.14, 15.98, 15.04, 14.35, 12.30, 12.07, 7.70, 7.60, 7.39, 7.33, 7.31, 7.27, 7.11, 6.99, 6.93, 6.07, 5.81, 5.60, 5.53, 5.49, 5.42, 5.40, 5.04, 4.59, -3.85, -3.99, -4.37, -4.42, -4.45, -4.57, -4.68, -5.10, -5.17; FTIR (neat film) 2954.1, 2933.4, 2877.0, 2858.3, 1752.3, 1675.5, 1458.6, 1379.5, 1251.0, 1099.8, 836.6, 777.8, 737.0, 697.0, 668.5 cm'; LRMS
(ESI) in/z: Calcd for C228H39oN2O45Si14Na2 (M+2Na++) 2157.24, found 2157.27.

151 of 205 Me Me OTBS,O Me OTBS,O Me HN H O OTBS
O Bn0 OBn H Ph O
lk~ TBSO OTBS
O O O O O
O Me Me H
Bn0 Me H O Bn0 OBn TESO OBn OTES O HCHOH H Me O 'Me O Me TESO
Me TESO O TES
'Me TESO OTES Me 248 Me Me TESO
O HO Me O HO Me HN H O OH
HO OH
O O O O HO OH HO O OH
Me Me H O_ HOZ Me OHOHO O OH OH
HO
HO O HO OH O O HCHOH H Me HOMeMe HOO Me HO O
HO, OH 1-9 HO
[00342] Compound 1-9. Three solutions of fully protected 1-9 248 (3 x 2.0 mg, 0.0014 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (3 x 1.0 mL) and ethanol (3 x 1.0 mL) in three 10-mL round bottom flasks were charged with 10% (dry basis) palladium on carbon, wet, Degussa type E101 NE/W (3 x 3.8 mg, 0.0054 mmol, 3.8 equiv). The three parallel reactions were stirred under hydrogen pressure (50 psi) for 24 h, and then the suspensions were each filtered through a 0.45 m polyvinylidene fluoride filter disk, washed with methanol (5 mL), and concentrated in a 25-mL round bottom flask.
[00343] A pre-cooled (0 C) solution of trifluoroacetic acid (1.0 mL, TFA/water 3:1) was added to each flask. After vigorous stirring for 75 min, the three parallel reactions were concentrated in vacuo for 1 h at 0 C to give white solid residue. This crude product was purified by RP-HPLC on an XBridge Prep BEH300 C18 column (5 m, 10 x 250 mm) using a linear gradient of 30-50% acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 30 min at a flow rate of 5 mL/min. The fraction containing the major peak (tR = 12.15 min) was collected and lyophilized to dryness to afford compound 1-9 (2.4 mg, 85% yield) as a white solid.
Characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, 7:3 D20:CD3CN) 6 9.36 (s, 1H), 5.34 (m, 1H), 5.31 (d, J= 7.9, 1H), 5.19 (d, J= 3.1, 1H), 5.17 (d, J= 1.5, 1H), 4.98 (d, J= 2.1, 1H), 4.67 (d, J= 7.8, 1H), 4.56 (d, J= 7.8, 1H), 4.51 (d, J= 7.7, 1H), 4.28 (d, J= 4.6, 1H), 4.06 (d, J=
10.1, 1H), 2.87 (dd, J= 14.6, 3.3, 1H), 2.43 (d, J= 6.6, 1H), 2.39 (dd, J=
7.5, 13.8, 1H), 2.33 152 of 205 (dd,J= 14.0, 5.3, 1H), 1.29 (s, 3H), 1.24 (d, J= 6.0, 3H), 1.08 (s, 3H), 0.94 (s, 3H), 0.90 (s, 3H), 0.68 (s, 3H); LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C92H149N2045 (M-H) 2001.94, found 2002.12.

O
HO O OTBS
NH2 H Ph TBSO OTBS Bn0 OBn \t~ I
O O O O
+ O o-BMe Me H H O O BO_OL OBn n 0 ~ O Me OTESO
O
TTESOO CHO H Me O 'Me O Me TESO OTES//C O H H TES Me Me Me TESO1~TES

O

TBSO
it BnO OBn H Ph O Me Me H
Bn0 ,, Me H O Bn0 O OBn OBn OTESO-O O O
TESO OTES O HCHOH H Me O 'Me O Me TESO
TESO O TES Me TESO\~/ Me Me TESO
[00344] Fully protected compound 1-10 (249). A solution of ethyl chloroformate (0.30 L, 0.0031 mmol, 2.0 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (10 L) was added to a solution of carboxylic acid 247 (2.1 mg, 0.0030 mmol, 2.0 equiv) and triethylamine (0.45 L, 0.0033 mmol, 2.1 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (1.0 mL) at 0 C. After 1.5 h, amino saponin 229 (5.0 mg, 0.0016 mmol, 1.0 equiv) was added in a solution of tetrahydrofuran (3.0 mL). The reaction was warmed slowly to 12 C over 14 h, concentrated, and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene to benzene/ethyl acetate 47:3) to afford 249 (5.4 mg, 89% yield) as a clear film.
Rf = 0.64 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1); characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.69 (s, 1H), 5.96 (s, 1H), 5.71 (s, 1H), 5.62 (m, 1H), 5.39 (d, J= 6.6, 1H), 5.28 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 5.19 (s, 1H), 5.09 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 4.85 (d, J= 11.2, 1H), 4.82 (d, J= 7.6, 1H), 4.79 (d, J=
10.6, 1H), 4.75 (d, J= 1.6, 1H), 4.64 (d, J= 11.2, 1H), 4.59 (d, J= 1.7, 2H), 4.18 (d, J= 7.3, 1H), 3.25 (m, 2H), 3.14 (dd, J= 19.6, 10.2, 2H), 2.88 (dd, J= 14.1, 3.5, 1H), 2.21 (t, J= 13.4, 1H), 2.14 (t, J= 7.4, 1H), 1.43 (s, 3H), 1.34 (s, 3H), 1.30 (s, 3H), 1.23 (s, 3H), 1.12 (d, J= 6.1, 3H); 13C NMR (126 MHz, CDC13) 6 138.24, 138.11, 137.64, 136.91, 135.44, 129.77, 128.64, 128.62, 128.57, 128.55, 128.51, 128.49, 128.45, 128.41, 128.29, 127.98, 127.93, 127.85, 127.62, 127.32, 109.64, 108.54, 107.38, 106.53, 91.72, 87.23, 84.34, 84.25, 81.46, 79.00, 78.89, 78.74, 153 of 205 78.67, 78.24, 74.25, 73.73, 73.65, 73.40, 73.11, 71.84, 71.57, 71.20, 67.87, 66.99, 63.87, 63.11, 54.03, 46.21, 41.71, 39.94, 37.06, 36.23, 32.86, 32.08, 30.60, 29.93, 29.88, 29.86, 29.81, 29.72, 29.67, 29.59, 29.46, 27.62, 26.53, 26.39, 26.08, 25.96, 25.90, 24.47, 22.86, 20.40, 18.53, 18.04, 18.00, 17.72, 17.32, 16.04, 14.27, 12.33, 7.70, 7.60, 7.39, 7.32, 7.29, 7.27, 7.12, 6.99, 6.93, 6.08, 5.81, 5.61, 5.53, 5.50, 5.42, 5.40, 5.08, 4.58, 1.19, -4.18, -4.38, -4.54, -4.64, -5.03, -5.16;
FTIR (neat film) 2952.9, 2929.0, 2876.6, 2856.9, 1750.9, 1734.2, 1457.5, 1241.6, 1219.9, 1099.2, 1006.0, 836.7, 737.2, 697.5 cm 1; LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C210H351NO42Si12Na2 (M+2Na++) 1970.62, found 1971.83.

TBSO
HN 11 '"r" _OTBS
TBSO
BnO OBn H Ph 11 O O O O O O O

O Me Me H
Bn Me H O BnO7OOBn OBn OTESO__l 0 O p O~O
TTES OTES O HCHOH H Me O 'Me O Me TESO
TES Me TESO O
Me TESO OTES 249 Me TESO p HO
I
HNx/õ`' M O O OH
HO OH HO
HO O OH
O O ZOH
Me Me H O OH
HOZC Me H H
HO HO~O OO
H HO OOHO O HCHOH H Me HOMeMe HO Me HOVH

HO
[00345] Compound 1-10. Fully protected 1-10 (249) (5.4 mg, 0.0014 mmol, 1.0 equiv) was equally divided into three 10-mL round bottom flasks and dissolved in tetrahydrofuran (3 x 1.0 mL) and ethanol (3 x 1.0 mL). The three parallel reactions were charged with 10% (dry basis) palladium on carbon, wet, Degussa type E101 NE/W (3 x 3.2 mg, 0.0045 mmol, 3.3 equiv) and stirred under hydrogen pressure (50 psi) for 24.5 h. The three suspensions were combined and filtered through two 0.45 m polyvinylidene fluoride filter disks, washed with methanol (5 mL), and concentrated in two 25-mL round bottom flasks.
[00346] A pre-cooled (0 C) solution of trifluoroacetic acid (1.0 mL, TFA/water 3:1) was added to both flasks. After vigorous stirring for 60 min, the two parallel reactions were concentrated in vacuo for 2 h at 0 C to afford white solid residue. This crude product was 154 of 205 purified by RP-HPLC on an XBridge Prep BEH300 C18 column (5 m, 10 x 250 mm) using a linear gradient of 30-40% acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 17 min at a flow rate of 5 mL/min. The fraction containing the major peak (tR = 15.5 min) was collected and lyophilized to dryness to afford compound 1-10 (2.0 mg, 78% yield) as an amorphous white solid. Characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, 7:3 D20:CD3CN) 6 9.36 (s, 4H), 5.34 (m, 1H), 5.32 (d, J= 7.9, 1H), 5.19 (d, J= 3.1, 1H), 5.17 (d, J= 1.4, 1H), 4.87 (d, J= 1.8, 1H), 4.67 (d, J= 7.7, 1H), 4.56 (d, J= 7.8, 1H), 4.52 (d, J= 7.9, 1H), 4.24 (d, J=
4.2, 1H), 4.06 (d, J
= 10.1, 1H), 3.96 (d, J= 3.1, 1H), 2.89 (dd, J= 14.3, 3.5, 1H), 1.08 (s, 3H), 0.94 (s, 3H), 0.92 (s, 3H), 0.85 (s, 3H), 0.68 (s, 3H); LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C86H138NO42 (M-H) 1856.87, found 1857.03.

O
CI Me 250 NH2 H Ph BnO OBn + O O O O O0 Me Bn0-ter Me Me H O BOnO O O OBn OBn OTESO O Me TTSo- OTES O HCHOH H Me O 'Me O
TESO O TES Me Me Me TESO1~TES

1 HN Me BnO OBn H Ph O Me Me H
Bn Me 4 H O Bn0 O OBn OBn OTESO 0 0_14,H O O2 TESO \ _OTES O HOH H Me O 'Me O Me TESO- T`' TESO O TES Me TESO 251 Me Me OTES
TESO
[00347] Fully protected compound 1-8 (251). Lauroyl chloride (6.6 L, 0.029 mmol, 12 equiv) was added to a solution of amine 229 (7.7 mg, 0.0024 mmol, 1.0 equiv) and tri-tert-butylpyridine (52.5 mg, 0.212 mmol, 89 equiv) in dichloromethane (10 mL).
After 16 h, the reaction was concentrated and purified by silica gel chromatography (benzene to benzene/ethyl acetate 4:1) to afford 251 (8.0 mg, 0.0023 mmol, 98% yield) as a clear film.
Rf= 0.58 (benzene/ethyl acetate 9:1); characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, CDC13) 6 9.70 (s, 1H), 5.96 (s, 1H), 5.71 (s, 1H), 5.62 (m, 1H), 5.38 (d, J 6.9, 1H), 5.30 (m, 1H), 5.28 (d, J

155 of 205 12.4, 1H), 5.20 (d, J= 1.6, 1H), 5.09 (d, J= 12.4, 1H), 4.64 (d, J= 11.2, 1H), 4.59 (d, J= 1.8, 2H), 4.18 (d, J= 7.3, I H), 3.25 (m, 2H), 3.14 (m, 2H), 2.88 (dd, J= 13.5, 3.0, I H), 2.21 (t, J=
13.8, 1H), 2.15 (t, J= 7.1, 1H), 1.44 (s, 3H), 1.12 (d, J= 6.1, 3H); 13C NMR
(126 MHz, CDC13) 6 138.25, 128.64, 128.61, 128.57, 128.55, 128.52, 128.48, 128.45, 128.41, 128.29, 127.98, 127.92, 127.85, 127.83, 127.62, 127.32, 112.24, 91.72, 74.25, 73.73, 73.64, 73.10, 63.86, 54.03, 46.16, 39.96, 36.22, 32.85, 32.08, 32.05, 31.02, 30.60, 30.43, 29.84, 29.76, 29.74, 29.61, 29.59, 29.53, 29.47, 29.39, 29.22, 27.61, 25.93, 25.51, 24.46, 22.84, 19.68, 17.73, 14.28, 7.69, 7.60, 7.39, 7.31, 7.27, 7.11, 6.99, 6.92, 6.07, 5.80, 5.60, 5.53, 5.49, 5.42, 5.39, 5.08, 4.58; FTIR (neat film) 2952.9, 2934.8, 2876.3, 1749.9, 1698.43, 1457.2, 1375.7, 1239.9, 1098.5, 1006.4, 697.5, 669.4 cm-1 ; LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C187H301NO37SigNa2 (M+2Na++) 1725.47, found 1723.82.

O
HN Me BnO OBn H Ph O Me Me H
Bn0 0 Me H OIB O OBn OBn OTES O O 0n2ZOj O
TESO OTES O HCHOH H Me O "Me O Me TESO TESO O TES Me Me TESO," CTES 251 Me O
TESO
HN Me HO OH
O O O O HOOOH
Me Me H O
OH
HOZ Me H OHOHO O OH
HO
HO HO HOH O O HCHOH H Me HOMeMe HOO Me O
HO OH SQS-0103 (207) HO
[00348] Compound 1-8. Three parallel solutions of fully protected 1-8 (251) (3 x 1.25 mg, 0.0011 mmol, 1.0 equiv) in tetrahydrofuran (3 x 1.0 mL) and ethanol (3 x 1.0 mL) in 10-mL
round bottom flasks were charged with 10% (dry basis) palladium on carbon, wet, Degussa type E101 NE/W (3 x 2.3 mg, 0.0054 mmol, 2.9 equiv). The three parallel reactions were stirred under hydrogen pressure (50 psi) for 26 h, and then the suspensions were combined and filtered through two 0.45 m polyvinylidene fluoride filter disks, washed with methanol (5 mL), and concentrated in two 25-mL round bottom flasks.

156 of 205
[00349] A pre-cooled (0 C) solution of trifluoroacetic acid (1.0 mL, TFA/water 1:1) was added to both parallel reactions. After vigorous stirring for 35 min, the reactions were concentrated in vacuo at 0 C to give white solid residue. This crude product was purified by RP-HPLC on an XBridge Prep BEH300 C18 column (5 m, 10 x 250 mm) using a linear gradient of 50-65% acetonitrile (0.05% TFA) in water (0.05% TFA) over 30 min at a flow rate of 5 mL/min. The product eluted as a broad peak (tR = 12.78 min), and this fraction was collected and lyophilized to dryness to afford compound 1-8 (1.3 mg, 0.00076 mmol, 69%
yield) as an amorphous solid. Characteristic resonances from iH NMR (500 MHz, 1:1 D20:CD3CN) 6 9.36 (s, 3H), 5.31 (m, 1H), 5.28 (d, J= 7.7, 1H), 5.19 (s, 1H), 5.17 (d, J= 3.1, 1H), 4.66 (d, J= 7.8, 1H), 4.53 (d, J= 7.8, 1H), 4.48 (d, J= 7.9, 1H), 4.40 (d, J= 7.7, 1H), 4.05 (d, J= 10.1, 2H), 3.95 (d, J= 3.1, 1H), 2.87 (m, 2H), 1.08 (s, 3H), 0.93 (s, 3H), 0.90 (s, 3H), 0.67 (s, 3H); LRMS (ESI) in/z: Calcd for C81H130NO37 (M-H) 1708.83, found 1709.37.

Example 4 Preclinical Evaluation of Synthetic QS-21 with GD3-KLH Conjugate Vaccine.
[00350] This example demonstrates the in vivo immunogenicity of certain compounds of the present invention. Using similar protocols, the immuno-potentiating properties of the synthetic adjuvants SQS-21-Api and SQS-21-Xyl were evaluated in mice (C57BL/6J, female, six weeks of age). Although our previous synthetic chemistry efforts had unambiguously verified the chemical structure of SQS-21-Api (Kim, Y.-J.; Wang, P.; Navarro-Villalobos, M.; Rohde, B. D.;
Derryberry, J.; Gin, D. Y. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 2006, 128, 11906-11915) and SQS-21-Xyl (Deng, K.; Adams, M. M.; Damani, P.; Livingston, P. 0.; Ragupathi, G.; Gin, D. Y.
Angew. Chem., Int.
Ed. 2008, 47, 6395-6398) as being identical to that of the principal constituents within NQS-21 (Wang, P.; Kim, Y.-J.; Navarro-Villalobos, M.; Rohde, B. D.; Gin, D. Y. J. Am.
Chem. Soc.
2005, 127, 3256-3257; Jacobsen, N. E.; Fairbrother, W. J.; Kensil, C. R.; Lim, A.; Wheeler, D.
A.; Powell, M. F. Carbohydr. Res. 1996, 280, 1-14), this experiment was undertaken to evaluate the synthetic saponins to verify their biological activity given the variable heterogeneity in composition within naturally derived NQS-21 (Note: NQS-21 = naturally derived QS-2 1; SQS-157 of 205 21-Mix = synthetic QS-21; SQS-21-Api = synthetic QS-21-Api; SQS-21-Xyl =
synthetic QS-21-Xyl; SQS-7 = synthetic QS-7). NQS-21 is isolated as a 65:35 mixture of its Apiose and Xylose isomeric forms, yet it is extremely difficult to separate these constituents from trace natural saponin impurities from the tree bark. As a result, it was necessary to explore whether there were any naturally derived trace saponin impurities that may function as the immuno-active constituent.
[00351] Groups of five mice were immunized with the melanoma antigen GD3 ganglioside conjugated to KLH (GD3-KLH) at a 10 g antigen dose per vaccination. As the negative control, mice were vaccinated with the GD3-KLH antigen only. As a positive control, vaccinations were performed with naturally derived NQS-21 (derived by fractionating a mixture of saponins from Quillaja saponaria) at a dose of 20 g, an amount known to induce measurable antibody responses with acceptable toxic effects in mice. Evaluation of the adjuvant activity of synthetic SQS-21 adjuvants at the same dose (20 g) included a reconstituted mixture of SQS-21-Api and SQS-21-Xyl in a 65:35 mixture (SQS-21-Mix) to mimic typical isomeric ratios found within NQS-21. Similar evaluations were performed on each of the separate saponin isomers, SQS-21-Api and SQS-21-Xyl at 20 g doses. Mice were immunized weekly for three weeks with the stated doses of specified adjuvants, and were bled 10 days after the third vaccination. Immunopotentiation was assessed by testing for the presence of antibody against GD3 and KLH by ELISA, and against a tumor cell-line SK-MEL-28, expressing GD3 antigen, by FACS.

Antibody Response (ELISA).
[00352] The antibody response after vaccination with GD3-KLH conjugate with or without adjuvant was determined with an ELISA assay using either GD3 ganglioside or KLH
protein as target. Comparison of the different adjuvants at the same doses (10 and 20 g) of SQS-21, SQS-21-Api and SQS-21-Xyl were all equally effective at inducing and IgM antibody response against GD3 after 3 weekly vaccinations with antibody titers in each case significantly higher than the group with GD3-KLH alone. After the third vaccination, no IgG
antibodies against GD3 were detected; however, after the fourth immunization IgM and IgG
antibody titers 158 of 205 were induced in most mice. Again, there were no significant differences between the various groups. The IgG antibody response against KLH was also strikingly elevated in all groups with no group demonstrating significantly higher or lower titers than the others.
All were at least 20 fold higher than the GD3-KLH alone group. A graphical representation (Figure 2) of the antibody titers at 20 g QS-adjuvant dose clearly illustrates that the SQS-21 adjuvants possess comparable adjuvant activity to that of NQS-21.

Cell Surface Reactivity by Flow Cytometry (FACS).
[00353] Immunopotentiation was also assessed by testing for the presence of antibody against a tumor cell-line SK-MEL-28) expressing GD3 antigen by FACS. Sera drawn 7 days after the 4th vaccination was tested for cell surface reactivity by flow cytometry using the SK-Mel-28 (GD3 positive) cell line. The median FACS results are represented graphically at 20 g QS-adjuvant dose for direct comparison (Figure 3). Presera obtained from mice before immunization showed less than 10% positive cells and sera from mice vaccinated with all three synthetic adjuvants showed significant positive reactivity with SK-Mel-28.
These data reinforce the comparable adjuvant activity of synthetic SQS-21 relative to that of NQS-21.

Toxicity.
[00354] As a measure of toxicity, loss of weight was monitored at 0 h, 24 h, 48 h and 72 h after each injection. The median weight loss for groups of five mice receiving SQS-21-Mix, SQS-21-Api or SQS-21-Xyl at the three different doses is demonstrated in Figure 4. As the negative control, vaccinations employing GD3-KLH only (no adjuvant) led to no appreciable weight loss after each injection. As the positive control, the presence of NQS-21 (20 g) elicited notable and expected weight loss after each injection. This pattern of weight loss over the 4-week duration is very similar to that of the other groups of mice vaccinated with SQS-21 synthetic adjuvants (mix, and separate isomers), again signaling a comparable biological profile of SQS-21 compared to that of NQS-21.

159 of 205 Example 5 Preclinical Evaluation of Selected Compounds of Formula II with GD3-KLH
Conjugate Vaccine.
[00355] Synthetic efforts have resulted in the preparation of compounds of formula H, including compounds 1-8, 1-9, and 1-10. In these compounds, structural variations within the hydrolytically labile acyl chain of natural QS compounds take the form of significantly more stable amide-linked constructs, along with dramatically simplified linear alkyl chain variants.
[00356] Groups of five mice were vaccinated (3x @ 1-wk intervals, booster @ wk 7) with GD3-KLH antigen (10 g) along with the adjuvant of interest (10 g). As a negative control, one group was vaccinated with the antigen only, devoid of adjuvant. As positive controls, two groups were vaccinated with either natural NQS-21 or synthetic SQS-21-Mix, both of which were established to be potent immunoadjuvants in this assay (see Figure 2). Three compounds of formula II, as well as our recently synthesized QS-7-Api adjuvant, were evaluated in parallel for comparison (Figure 5).
[00357] Antibodies to GD3 in the blood samples were measured by ELISA (Figure 5A).
These preliminary data reveal that these synthetic compounds are at least as active as NQS-21 in terms of immunopotentiating ability. These activities are reinforced by the strikingly high Ab titers (0.8-1.6 x 106, Figure 5B) against the protein antigen KLH. Detailed toxicity assessment of these novel adjuvants is currently underway.
[00358] This important collection of preliminary data (Figure 5) establishes the concepts that: (1) hydrolytically stable compounds of formula II are active immunopotentiators; and (2) that the present invention provides novel and potent adjuvant compounds with potencies that rival and exceed that of natural NQS-21.

160 of 205

Claims (81)

What is claimed is:
1. A compound of formula I:

or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
is a single or double bond;

W is Me, -CHO, V is hydrogen or -OR x;

Y is CH2, -O-, -NR-, or -NH-;
Z is hydrogen, a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, and heteroaryl; or Z
comprises a carbohydrate;
each occurrence of R x is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates;
R y is -OH, -OR, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;

each occurrence of R x' is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1-6 aliphatic, or C1-6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R x' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, C1-12 aliphatic, or C1-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
with the provisos that a carbohydrate domain directly attached to Y is not fucosyl; that Y-Z is not -OH or -OMe if all R x groups are hydrogen or if at least four R x groups are methyl; and that the compound is not one of the following:

2. The compound of claim 1, wherein Z is a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, and heteroaryl; or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

wherein:
each occurrence of R1 is R x or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
wherein:
each occurrence of a, b, and c is independently 0, 1, or 2;
d is an integer from 1-5, wherein each d bracketed structure may be the same or different; with the proviso that the d bracketed structure represents a furanose or pyranose moiety, and the sum of b and c is 1 or 2;

R0 is hydrogen, an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates; or an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R a, R b, R c, and R d is independently hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR x, NR2, NHCOR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R2 is hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OC(O)R4, OC(O)OR4, OC(O)NHR4, OC(O)NRR4, OC(O)SR4, NHC(O)R4, NRC(O)R4, NHC(O)OR4, NHC(O)NHR4, NHC(O)NRR4, N(R4)2, NHR4, NRR4, N3, or an optionally substituted group selected from C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R3 is hydrogen, halogen, CH2OR1, or an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; with the proviso that R3 is not methyl;

wherein X is -O- or -NR-; or T-R z, wherein:

T is a covalent bond or a bivalent C1-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain; and R z is hydrogen, halogen, -OR, -OR x, -OR1, -SR, -NR2, -NC(O)OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur; or two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
3. The compound according to claim 2, wherein Z is a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

4. The compound according to claim 3, wherein each occurrence of R1 is independently hydrogen or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

5. The compound according to claim 4, wherein each occurrence of R1 is independently selected from the group consisting of:

wherein R5 and R6 are independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-io aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
6. The compound according to claim 3, wherein R2 is N3, OC(O)R4, OC(O)NHR4, NHC(O)R4, NRC(O)R4, NHC(O)OR4, or NHC(O)NHR4.
7. The compound according to claim 3, wherein R2 is N3.
8. The compound according to claim 3, wherein R2 is OC(O)R4.
9. The compound according to claim 3, wherein R2 is NHC(O)R4.
10. The compound according to claim 6, 7, 8, or 9 wherein R4 is methyl.
11. The compound according to claim 6, 7, 8, or 9 wherein R4 is
12. The compound according to claim 11, wherein R is hydrogen and R1' is
13. The compound according to claim 9, wherein R4 is -T-R z.
14. The compound according to claim 13, wherein T is a covalent bond or a bivalent C1-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain comprising one or two units of -O-.
15. The compound according to claim 14, wherein -T- is selected from
16. The compound according to claim 13, wherein R z is hydrogen, halogen, -OR
x, OR1, -OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, C1-6 aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen or sulfur.
17. The compound according to claim 16, wherein R z is selected from hydrogen, methyl, or
18. The compound according to claim 5, wherein each of R3, R5, and R6 is independently an optionally substituted C1-10 aliphatic group.
19. The compound according to claim 18, wherein each of R5 and R6 is independently methyl.
20. The compound according to claim 18, wherein each of R3, R5, and R6 is independently CH2OR.
21. The compound according to claim 18, wherein one or more of R3, R5, and R6 is CH2OH.
22. The compound according to claim 18, wherein each of R3, R5, and R6 is CH2OH.
23. The compound according to any one of claims 1-22, wherein each occurrence of R x is independently an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of methyl ethers, ethyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates.
24. The compound according to claim 23, wherein each R x is independently benzyl or -SiR3.
25. The compound according to claim 23, wherein two R x attached to adjacent carbon atoms on a saccharide ring are taken together to form a cyclic acetal or ketal protecting group.
26. The compound according to any one of claims 1-22, wherein all R x are hydrogen.
27. The compound according to any one of claims 1-22, wherein R y is a carboxyl protecting group.
28. The compound according to claim 27, wherein R y is benzyl.
29. The compound according to any one of claims 1-22, wherein R y is hydrogen.
30. The compound according to claim 1, wherein R s is
31. The compound according to claim 1, wherein R s is
32. The compound according to any one of claims 1-22, wherein W is -CHO.
33. The compound according to any one of claims 1-22, wherein V is -OH.
34. The compound according to any one of claims 1-22, wherein V is hydrogen.
35. The compound according to any one of claims 1-22, wherein Y is -O-.
36. The compound according to claim 1, wherein the compound is of formula II:
37. A compound of formula II-b:

or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
~ is a single or double bond;

W is Me, -CHO, -CH2OR x, or -C(O)R y;
V is hydrogen or -OR x;
each occurrence of R x is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates;
R y is -OH, -OR, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;

R s is each occurrence of R x is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1-6 aliphatic, or C1-6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R x' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, C1-12 aliphatic, or C1-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R1 is R x or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
wherein:
each occurrence of a, b, and c is independently 0, 1, or 2;
d is an integer from 1-5, wherein each d bracketed structure may be the same or different; with the proviso that the d bracketed structure represents a furanose or pyranose moiety, and the sum of b and c is 1 or 2;
R0 is hydrogen, an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates; or an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R a, R b, R c, and R d is independently hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR x, NR2, NHCOR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R3 is hydrogen, halogen, CH2OR1, or an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; with the proviso that R3 is not methyl;

R4 is wherein X is -O- or -NR-; or T-R z, wherein:
T is a covalent bond or a bivalent C1-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain; and R z is hydrogen, halogen, -OR, -OR x, -OR1, -SR, -NR2, -NC(O)OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur; or two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
38. A compound selected from:

39. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound according to any one of claims 1 through 38 and a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
40. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 39 further comprising an immunologically effective amount of an antigen.
41. A vaccine comprising:
a) one or more bacterial, viral, protozoal, or tumor-associated antigens, and b) one or more compounds of claims 1 through 38.
42. The vaccine of claim 41, wherein said one or more antigens are bacterial antigens.
43. The vaccine of claim 40, wherein said bacterial antigens are antigens associated with a bacterium selected from the group consisting of Helicobacter pylori, Chlamydia pneumoniae, Chlamydia trachomatis, Ureaplasma urealyticum, Mycoplasma pneumoniae, Staphylococcus spp., Staphylococcus aureus, Streptococcus spp., Streptococcus pyogenes, Streptococcus pneumoniae, Streptococcus viridans, Enterococcusfaecalis, Neisseria meningitidis, Neisseria gonorrhoeae, Bacillus anthracis, Salmonella spp., Salmonella typhi, Vibrio cholera, Pasteurella pestis, Pseudomonas aeruginosa, Campylobacter spp., Campylobacterjejuni, Clostridium spp., Clostridium difficile, Mycobacterium spp., Mycobacterium tuberculosis, Treponema spp., Borrelia spp., Borrelia burgdorferi, Leptospria spp., Hemophilus ducreyi, Corynebacterium diphtheria, Bordetella pertussis, Bordetella parapertussis, Bordetella bronchiseptica, hemophilus influenza, Escherichia coli, Shigella spp., Erlichia spp., Rickettsia spp. and combinations thereof.
44. The vaccine of claim 41, wherein said one or more antigens are viral-associated antigens.
45. The vaccine of claim 44, wherein said viral-associated antigens are antigens associated with a virus selected from the group consisting of influenza viruses, parainfluenza viruses, mumps virus, adenoviruses, respiratory syncytial virus, Epstein-Barr virus, rhinoviruses, polioviruses, coxsackieviruses, echo viruses, rubeola virus, rubella virus, varicell-zoster virus, herpes viruses, herpes simplex virus, parvoviruses, cytomegalovirus, hepatitis viruses, human papillomavirus, alphaviruses, flaviviruses, bunyaviruses, rabies virus, arenaviruses, filoviruses, HIV 1, HIV 2, HTLV- 1, HTLV-II, FeLV, bovine LV, FeIV, canine distemper virus, canine contagious hepatitis virus, feline calicivirus, feline rhinotracheitis virus, TGE virus, foot and mouth disease virus, and combinations thereof.
46. The vaccine of claim 41, wherein said one or more antigens are tumor-associated antigens are antigens selected from the group consisting of killed tumor cells and lysates thereof, MAGE-1, MAGE-3 and peptide fragments thereof; human chorionic gonadotropin and peptide fragments thereof; carcinoembryonic antigen and peptide fragments thereof, alpha fetoprotein and peptide fragments thereof; pancreatic oncofetal antigen and peptide fragments thereof;
MUC-1 and peptide fragments thereof, CA 125, CA 15-3, CA 19-9, CA 549, CA 195 and peptide fragments thereof; prostate-specific antigens and peptide fragments thereof; prostate-specific membrane antigen and peptide fragments thereof; squamous cell carcinoma antigen and peptide fragments thereof; ovarian cancer antigen and peptide fragments thereof; pancreas cancer associated antigen and peptide fragments thereof; Her1/neu and peptide fragments thereof; gp-100 and peptide fragments thereof; mutant K-ras proteins and peptide fragments thereof; mutant p53 and peptide fragments thereof; truncated epidermal growth factor receptor, chimeric protein p210BCR-ABL KH-1, N3, GM1, GM2, Gb3, GD2, GD3, Globo-H, STn, Tn, Lewis x, Lewis y, TF;
and mixtures thereof.
47. The vaccine of claim 41, wherein said one or more antigens are non-covalently associated with a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
48. The vaccine of claim 41, wherein said one or more antigens are conjugated covalently to a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
49. A method of potentiating an immune response to an antigen, comprising administering to a subject a vaccine of claim 41 in an effective amount to potentiate the immune response of said subject to said antigen.
50. A method of vaccinating a subject, comprising administering a vaccine of claim 41 to said subject.
51. The method of claim 49 or 50, wherein the subject is a human.
52. The method of claim 50, wherein the vaccine is administered orally.
53. The method of claim 50, wherein the vaccine is administered intramuscularly.
54. The method of claim 50, wherein the vaccine is administered subcutaneously.
55. The method of claim 50, wherein the amount of compound administered is 10-1000 µg.
56. The method of claim 50, wherein the amount of compound administered is 500-1000 µg.
57. The method of claim 50, wherein the amount of compound administered is 100-500 µg.
58. The method of claim 50, wherein the amount of compound administered is 50-250 µg.
59. The method of claim 50, wherein the amount of compound administered is 50-500 µg.
60. The method of claim 50, wherein the amount of compound administered is 250-500 µg.
61. A kit comprising a pharmaceutical composition of claim 39 or 40 and instructions for administration.
62. A kit of claim 61 further comprising prescribing information.
63. A kit of claim 61 further comprising a device for administration.
64. A kit of claim 61 wherein the kit comprises multiple doses of a pharmaceutical composition.
65. A method comprising the steps of:
(a) providing a mixture of prosapogenins of formula IV-a:
wherein:
is a single or double bond;

Y' is hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR y, OH, NR2, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;

W is Me, -CHO, , -CH2OR x, or -C(O)R y;
V is hydrogen or -OR x;

R y is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;

R S1 is each occurrence of R x' is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1-6 aliphatic, or C1-6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R x' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, C1-12 aliphatic, or C1-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R x is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;
(b) treating said compound of formula IV-a under suitable conditions to form a mixture of prosapogenins of formula IV:

wherein each of , R y, Y', V, and W is as defined for compounds of formula IV-a, and each occurrence of R x is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;

R s is with the proviso that at least one R x group is not hydrogen;
and (c) obtaining said compound IV by suitable physical means.
66. The method according to claim 65, wherein the mixture of prosapogenins comprises compounds A and B:

67. The method according to claim 66, wherein compound of formula IV-a is compound A.
68. The method according to claim 66, wherein the compound of formula IV is:

69. The method according to claim 65, wherein each R x is independently trialkylsilyl or arylalkyl.
70. The method according to claim 69, wherein R x is -SiEt3 or benzyl.
71. The method according to claim 65, wherein W is CHO.
72. The method according to claim 65, wherein V is OH for a compound of formula IV-a and OR x for a compound of formula IV.
73. The method according to claim 65, wherein the suitable physical means is chromatography.
74. A method comprising the steps of:
(a) providing a compound of formula IV:

wherein:
is a single or double bond;
Y' is hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR y, OH, NR2, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;
W is Me, -CHO, -CH2OR x, or -C(O)R y;

V is hydrogen or -OR x;
R y is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;
R s is each occurrence of R x' is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1-6 aliphatic, or C1-6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R x' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, C1-12 aliphatic, or C1-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

each occurrence of R x is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;
with the provisos that at least one R x group is not hydrogen; that Y' is not -OH or -OMe if all R x groups are hydrogen or if at least four R x groups are methyl; and that a compound of formula IV is not:

(b) treating said compound of formula IV under suitable conditions with a compound of formula V:

wherein:
Z is a cyclic or acyclic, optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, aliphatic, heteroaliphatic, aryl, arylalkyl, and heteroaryl; or Z
comprises a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

wherein:
each occurrence of R1 is R x or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:

wherein:
each occurrence of a, b, and c is independently 0, 1, or 2;
d is an integer from 1-5, wherein each d bracketed structure may be the same or different;
with the proviso that the d bracketed structure represents a furanose or pyranose moiety, and the sum of b and c is 1 or 2;
R0 is hydrogen, an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates;
or an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R a, R b, R c, and R d is independently hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR x, NR2, NHCOR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R2 is hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OC(O)R4, OC(O)OR4, OC(O)NHR4, OC(O)NRR4, OC(O)SR4, NHC(O)R4, NRC(O)R4, NHC(O)OR4, NHC(O)NHR4, NHC(O)NRR4, N(R4)2, NHR4, NRR4, N3, or an optionally substituted group selected from C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

R3 is hydrogen, halogen, CH2OR1, or an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

R4 is wherein X is -O- or -NR-; or T-R z, wherein:
T is a covalent bond or a bivalent C1-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain; and R z is hydrogen, halogen, -OR, -OR x, -OR1, -SR, -NR2, -NC(O)OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur; or two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R x is as defined for compounds of formula IV; and LG is a suitable leaving group selected from the group consisting of halogen, alkoxy, sulphonyloxy, optionally substituted alkylsulphonyl, optionally substituted alkenylsulfonyl, optionally substituted arylsulfonyl, and diazonium moieties;
or a suitable glycoside donor leaving group;
to give a compound of formula I:

wherein each of -, R x, R y, R s, Z, V, and W is as defined for compounds of formula IV or V, and Y is CH2, -O-, -NR-, or -NH-.
75. The method according to claim 74, wherein the compound of formula V is a compound of formula VI:

wherein:
each occurrence of R1 is R x or a carbohydrate domain having the structure:
wherein:
each occurrence of a, b, and c is independently 0, 1, or 2;
d is an integer from 1-5, wherein each d bracketed structure may be the same or different; with the proviso that the d bracketed structure represents a furanose or pyranose moiety, and the sum of b and c is 1 or 2;
R0 is hydrogen, an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, carbamates, and carbonates; or an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R a, R b, R c, and R d is independently hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OR x, NR2, NHCOR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R2 is hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OC(O)R4, OC(O)OR4, OC(O)NHR4, OC(O)NRR4, OC(O)SR4, NHC(O)R4, NRC(O)R4, NHC(O)OR4, NHC(O)NHR4, NHC(O)NRR4, N(R4)2, NHR4, NRR4, N3, or an optionally substituted group selected from C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-1 0-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R3 is hydrogen, halogen, CH2OR1, or an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;

R4 is , wherein X is -O- or -NR-; or T-R z, wherein:
T is a covalent bond or a bivalent C1-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain; and R z is hydrogen, halogen, -OR, -OR x, -OR 1, -SR, -NR2, -NC(O)OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur; or two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, C1-6 aliphatic, or C1-6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; and LG1 is a glycoside donor leaving group.
76. The method according to claim 75, wherein the compound is of formulae VI-1, VI-2, VI-3, VI-4, VI-5, VI-6, VI-7, or VI-8:

wherein:
R2 is hydrogen, halogen, OH, OR, OC(O)R4, OC(O)OR4, OC(O)NHR4, OC(O)NRR4, OC(O)SR4, NHC(O)R4, NRC(O)R4, NHC(O)OR4, NHC(O)NHR4, NHC(O)NRR4, N(R4)2, NHR4, NRR4, N3, or an optionally substituted group selected from C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R3 is hydrogen, halogen, CH2OR1, or an optionally substituted group selected from the group consisting of acyl, C1-10 aliphatic, C1-6 heteroaliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, arylalkyl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
R4 is wherein X is -O- or -NR-; or T-R z, wherein:
T is a covalent bond or a bivalent C1-26 saturated or unsaturated, straight or branched, aliphatic or heteroaliphatic chain; and R z is hydrogen, halogen, -OR, -OR x, -OR1, -SR, -NR2, -NC(O)OR, or an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, aliphatic, 6-10-membered aryl, 5-10-membered heteroaryl having 1-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, 4-7-membered heterocyclyl having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur; or two R4 on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R x is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group selected from the group consisting of alkyl ethers, benzyl ethers, silyl ethers, acetals, ketals, esters, and carbonates;

R y is -OH, -OR, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, C1-12 aliphatic, or C1-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:
two R on the same nitrogen atom are taken with the nitrogen to form a 4-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; and LG1 is a glycoside donor leaving group.
77. The method according to claim 75, wherein the compound of formula VI is selected from:

78. The method according to claim 74, wherein the compound of formula IV is of formula IV-b:

79. The method according to claim 74, wherein the compound of formula IV is:

80. The method according to claim 74, wherein the compound of formula I is of formula I-a:

81. A compound of formula IV:

wherein:
is a single or double bond;
Y' is hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, aryl, OR, OR, OH, NR2, NR3+, NHR, NH2, SR, or NROR;

W is Me, -CHO, -CH2OR x, or -C(O)R y;
V is hydrogen or -OR;
R y is -OH, or a carboxyl protecting group selected from the group consisting of ester, amides, and hydrazides;

R s is each occurrence of R x' is independently an optionally substituted group selected from 6-10-membered aryl, C1-6 aliphatic, or C1-6 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur; or:

two R x' are taken together to form a 5-7-membered heterocyclic ring having 1-heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R is independently hydrogen, an optionally substituted group selected from acyl, arylalkyl, 6-10-membered aryl, C1-12 aliphatic, or C1-12 heteroaliphatic having 1-2 heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting of nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur;
each occurrence of R x is independently hydrogen or an oxygen protecting group;
with the provisos that at least one R x is an oxygen protecting group; that when Y' is -OH, -OMe, or -Oallyl, at least seven R x groups are silyl ethers; and that no more than four R x groups can simutaneously be methyl groups;
with the provisos that Y' is not -OH or -OMe if all R x groups are hydrogen or if at least four R x groups are methyl; and that the compound is not one of the following:

CA2720771A 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof Active CA2720771C (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
CA2993582A CA2993582C (en) 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US4319708P 2008-04-08 2008-04-08
US61/043,197 2008-04-08
PCT/US2009/039954 WO2009126737A2 (en) 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
CA2993582A Division CA2993582C (en) 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
CA2720771A1 true CA2720771A1 (en) 2009-10-15
CA2720771C CA2720771C (en) 2018-03-20

Family

ID=40875147

Family Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
CA2993582A Active CA2993582C (en) 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof
CA3096084A Active CA3096084C (en) 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof
CA2720771A Active CA2720771C (en) 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof

Family Applications Before (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
CA2993582A Active CA2993582C (en) 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof
CA3096084A Active CA3096084C (en) 2008-04-08 2009-04-08 Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof

Country Status (11)

Country Link
US (5) US8283456B2 (en)
EP (3) EP3357931B1 (en)
JP (5) JP5706815B2 (en)
KR (6) KR102256410B1 (en)
CN (2) CN104710487A (en)
AU (1) AU2009233757B2 (en)
CA (3) CA2993582C (en)
ES (1) ES2827804T3 (en)
HK (1) HK1211591A1 (en)
IL (4) IL208535A (en)
WO (1) WO2009126737A2 (en)

Families Citing this family (31)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CA2993582C (en) 2008-04-08 2020-12-15 Sloan-Kettering Institute For Cancer Research Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof
CN102068446B (en) * 2011-01-10 2013-08-21 武汉道一堂医药研究院 Application of triterpenoid saponin compound in preparation of anti-pathogeny microorganism medicament
AU2013204005B2 (en) * 2012-05-23 2015-04-16 Oncology Research International Limited Improved synthesis
CA3044471C (en) 2013-01-04 2021-05-11 Obi Pharma, Inc. Vaccines with higher carbohydrate antigen density and novel saponin adjuvant
US10806119B2 (en) 2013-06-05 2020-10-20 Yeda Research And Development Co. Ltd. Plant with altered content of steroidal alkaloids
EP3149015B1 (en) * 2014-05-30 2021-07-21 Memorial Sloan-Kettering Cancer Center Minimal saponin analogues, synthesis and use thereof
JP2018532990A (en) 2015-09-04 2018-11-08 オービーアイ ファーマ,インコーポレイテッド Glycan arrays and methods of use
JP6900385B2 (en) 2015-11-06 2021-07-07 アジュバンス・テクノロジーズ・インコーポレーテッド Triterpenoid saponin analogue
US10980894B2 (en) 2016-03-29 2021-04-20 Obi Pharma, Inc. Antibodies, pharmaceutical compositions and methods
CA3019560A1 (en) 2016-03-29 2017-10-05 Obi Pharma, Inc. Antibodies, pharmaceutical compositions and methods
SG11201809024UA (en) 2016-04-22 2018-11-29 Obi Pharma Inc Cancer immunotherapy by immune activation or immune modulation via globo series antigens
CA3032049C (en) 2016-07-27 2023-11-07 Obi Pharma, Inc. Immunogenic/therapeutic glycan compositions and uses thereof
TWI786054B (en) 2016-07-29 2022-12-11 台灣浩鼎生技股份有限公司 Human antibodies, pharmaceutical compositions and methods
AU2017361549B2 (en) 2016-11-21 2023-12-21 Obi Pharma, Inc. Conjugated biological molecules, pharmaceutical compositions and methods
US11129906B1 (en) 2016-12-07 2021-09-28 David Gordon Bermudes Chimeric protein toxins for expression by therapeutic bacteria
KR20190137808A (en) * 2017-04-13 2019-12-11 아쥬반스 테크놀로지스 인코포레이티드 Triterpene Saponins, Intermediates and Adjuvant Combinations
CN110582282A (en) * 2017-04-25 2019-12-17 佐剂技术公司 Triterpene saponin analogues
EP3615039A4 (en) * 2017-04-25 2021-01-13 Adjuvance Technologies, Inc. Triterpene saponin analogues
US11324821B2 (en) * 2017-10-16 2022-05-10 Adjuvance Technologies, Inc. Triterpene saponin analogues
CA3085356A1 (en) 2017-12-29 2019-07-04 Glycomimetics, Inc. Heterobifunctional inhibitors of e-selectin and galectin-3
US20210040143A1 (en) * 2018-03-20 2021-02-11 The Uab Research Foundation Saponin-based vaccine adjuvants
US11203645B2 (en) 2018-06-27 2021-12-21 Obi Pharma, Inc. Glycosynthase variants for glycoprotein engineering and methods of use
WO2020055503A1 (en) 2018-09-14 2020-03-19 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Nanoparticle vaccine adjuvant and methods of use thereof
KR20210110645A (en) 2018-12-27 2021-09-08 글리코미메틱스, 인크. Galectin-3 Inhibitory C-Glycoside
WO2020139962A1 (en) 2018-12-27 2020-07-02 Glycomimetics, Inc. Heterobifunctional inhibitors of e-selectin and galectin-3
WO2021091997A1 (en) * 2019-11-05 2021-05-14 Adjuvance Technologies, Inc. Varicella zoster
WO2021195024A1 (en) * 2020-03-23 2021-09-30 Adjuvance Technologies, Inc. Adjuvant compounds, salt forms, and formulations
WO2023052829A1 (en) * 2021-10-02 2023-04-06 Desert King Chile S.A A 3-o-monodesmosidic saponins extract, stable at physiological ph, method for preparing it from a quillaja plant extract cultured with a microbial consortium, uses and such microbial consortium
EP4190359A1 (en) 2021-12-03 2023-06-07 Asociación Centro de Investigación Cooperativa en Biociencias - CIC bioGUNE Saponin-based adjuvants and vaccines
US20230190920A1 (en) 2021-12-19 2023-06-22 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Compositions and methods for long-lasting germinal center responses to a priming immunization
WO2023139145A1 (en) 2022-01-19 2023-07-27 Asociación Centro De Investigación Cooperativa En Biociencias-Cic Biogune Saponin-based adjuvants and vaccines

Family Cites Families (18)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JPS6112695A (en) * 1984-06-28 1986-01-21 Rikagaku Kenkyusho Sialic acid derivative
US5057540A (en) * 1987-05-29 1991-10-15 Cambridge Biotech Corporation Saponin adjuvant
US5583112A (en) 1987-05-29 1996-12-10 Cambridge Biotech Corporation Saponin-antigen conjugates and the use thereof
JPH09169648A (en) * 1995-12-22 1997-06-30 Nippon Shinyaku Co Ltd Medicine composition
CA2273922C (en) * 1996-12-02 2008-08-05 Aquila Biopharmaceuticals, Inc. Novel saponin compositions and uses thereof
US6231859B1 (en) * 1996-12-02 2001-05-15 Aquila Biopharmaceuticals, Inc. Saponin adjuvant compositions
AU732856B2 (en) 1997-05-20 2001-05-03 Galenica Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Triterpene saponin analogs having adjuvant and immunostimulatory activity
US6080725A (en) 1997-05-20 2000-06-27 Galenica Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Immunostimulating and vaccine compositions employing saponin analog adjuvants and uses thereof
WO1998056415A1 (en) * 1997-06-11 1998-12-17 Aquila Biopharmaceuticals, Inc. Purified saponins as oral adjuvants
WO2000009075A2 (en) * 1998-08-14 2000-02-24 Galenica Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Chemically modified saponins and the use thereof as adjuvants
US7457415B2 (en) 1998-08-20 2008-11-25 Akikaze Technologies, Llc Secure information distribution system utilizing information segment scrambling
US6716428B1 (en) 1999-10-06 2004-04-06 The Ohio State University Research Foundation Antigenic modification of polypeptides
US20040242502A1 (en) * 2003-04-08 2004-12-02 Galenica Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Semi-synthetic saponin analogs with carrier and immune stimulatory activities for DNA and RNA vaccines
AU2006243737A1 (en) * 2005-05-04 2006-11-09 National Research Council Of Canada Method for production of Saponaria from microspores
CN100335073C (en) * 2005-08-19 2007-09-05 浙江大学 Process for preparing semen momordicae seed extract containing triterpene saponin component
CA2993582C (en) 2008-04-08 2020-12-15 Sloan-Kettering Institute For Cancer Research Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof
CN101322734B (en) 2008-07-22 2013-05-29 沈阳药科大学 Codonopsis lanceolata total saponins with anti-inflammatory immunity function and preparation thereof
EP3149015B1 (en) * 2014-05-30 2021-07-21 Memorial Sloan-Kettering Cancer Center Minimal saponin analogues, synthesis and use thereof

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
AU2009233757B2 (en) 2015-05-07
US11447515B2 (en) 2022-09-20
US9718850B2 (en) 2017-08-01
IL237505A (en) 2017-06-29
KR102085687B1 (en) 2020-03-06
JP2017114876A (en) 2017-06-29
JP2015134793A (en) 2015-07-27
IL208535A (en) 2015-06-30
JP6770596B2 (en) 2020-10-14
KR20180014211A (en) 2018-02-07
KR101651695B1 (en) 2016-08-26
US20130011421A1 (en) 2013-01-10
IL239051B (en) 2021-03-25
CA2993582A1 (en) 2009-10-15
KR101825315B1 (en) 2018-02-02
US20110300177A1 (en) 2011-12-08
IL237505A0 (en) 2015-04-30
CA2993582C (en) 2020-12-15
KR101947332B1 (en) 2019-02-12
AU2009233757A1 (en) 2009-10-15
US8283456B2 (en) 2012-10-09
US8889842B2 (en) 2014-11-18
EP3357931A1 (en) 2018-08-08
JP6786410B2 (en) 2020-11-18
KR20200024964A (en) 2020-03-09
WO2009126737A3 (en) 2010-01-14
US20150086585A1 (en) 2015-03-26
CN102112484B (en) 2015-03-04
CA3096084A1 (en) 2009-10-15
EP3357931B1 (en) 2020-07-22
KR20110003523A (en) 2011-01-12
CA2720771C (en) 2018-03-20
IL208535A0 (en) 2010-12-30
IL239051A0 (en) 2015-07-30
EP3868771A1 (en) 2021-08-25
JP2011516566A (en) 2011-05-26
CN104710487A (en) 2015-06-17
HK1211591A1 (en) 2016-05-27
JP5706815B2 (en) 2015-04-22
EP2280987A2 (en) 2011-02-09
IL281261B (en) 2022-11-01
JP2019073530A (en) 2019-05-16
KR20160103156A (en) 2016-08-31
US20230131867A1 (en) 2023-04-27
JP2020169206A (en) 2020-10-15
KR102256410B1 (en) 2021-05-26
CN102112484A (en) 2011-06-29
US20170283450A1 (en) 2017-10-05
CA3096084C (en) 2022-12-20
IL281261A (en) 2021-04-29
IL281261B2 (en) 2023-03-01
EP2280987B1 (en) 2018-05-23
KR102453184B1 (en) 2022-10-07
WO2009126737A2 (en) 2009-10-15
ES2827804T3 (en) 2021-05-24
KR20210062717A (en) 2021-05-31
KR20190016595A (en) 2019-02-18

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US20230131867A1 (en) Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis and uses thereof
AU2021266246B2 (en) Triterpene saponins, methods of synthesis, and uses thereof

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
EEER Examination request

Effective date: 20140402